4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
27 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
28 @c =======================================
30 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
31 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
35 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
37 @c orgkey{key} A key item
38 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
39 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
40 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
41 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
42 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
43 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
44 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
46 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
47 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
49 @c a key but no command
61 @c one key with a command
62 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
63 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
71 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
80 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
81 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
82 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
90 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
99 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
100 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
101 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
108 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
116 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
117 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
118 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
126 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
135 @c two keys with one command
136 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
137 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
152 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
156 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
158 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
159 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
160 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
167 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
171 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
182 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
183 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
184 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
199 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
203 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
204 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
205 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
220 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
224 @c two keys with two commands
225 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
226 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
227 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
234 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
235 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
238 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
239 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
249 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
252 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
255 @c Subheadings inside a table.
256 @macro tsubheading{text}
258 @subsubheading \text\
266 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
268 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
271 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
272 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
273 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
274 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
275 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
276 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
278 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
279 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
280 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
282 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
283 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
284 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
285 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
289 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
291 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
295 @title The Org Manual
297 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
298 @author by Carsten Dominik
299 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
301 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
303 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
307 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
311 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
318 * Introduction:: Getting started
319 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
320 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
321 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
322 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
323 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
324 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
325 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
326 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
327 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
328 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
329 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
330 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
331 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
332 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
333 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
334 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
335 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
336 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
337 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
338 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
339 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
342 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
346 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
347 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
348 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
349 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
350 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
354 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
355 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
356 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
357 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
358 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
359 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
360 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
361 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
362 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
363 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
364 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
368 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
369 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
370 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
371 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
372 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
373 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
377 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
378 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
379 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
380 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
381 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
382 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
383 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
384 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
385 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
389 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
390 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
391 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
392 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
393 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
394 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
395 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
396 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
400 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
404 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
405 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
406 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
407 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
408 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
409 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
411 Extended use of TODO keywords
413 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
414 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
415 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
416 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
417 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
418 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
419 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
423 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
424 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
425 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
429 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
430 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
431 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
433 Properties and columns
435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
444 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
445 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
446 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
450 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
451 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
455 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
456 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
457 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
458 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
459 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
460 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
461 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
465 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
466 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
468 Deadlines and scheduling
470 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
471 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
475 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
476 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
477 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
479 Capture - Refile - Archive
481 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
482 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
483 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
484 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
485 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
486 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
490 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
491 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
492 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
496 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
497 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
501 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
502 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
506 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
507 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
508 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
509 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
510 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
511 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
512 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
513 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
515 The built-in agenda views
517 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
518 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
519 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
520 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
521 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
522 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
524 Presentation and sorting
526 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
527 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
528 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
532 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
533 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
534 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
536 Markup for rich export
538 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
539 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
540 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
541 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
542 * Index entries:: Making an index
543 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
544 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
546 Structural markup elements
548 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
549 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
550 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
551 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
553 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
554 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
555 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
556 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
557 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
561 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
562 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
563 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
564 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
565 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
569 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
570 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
571 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
572 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
573 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
574 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
575 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
576 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
577 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
578 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
579 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
580 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
584 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
585 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
586 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
587 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
588 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
589 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
590 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
591 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
592 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
593 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
595 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
597 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
598 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
599 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
600 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
601 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
602 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
606 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
607 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
608 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
609 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
610 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
611 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
613 OpenDocument Text export
615 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
616 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
617 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
618 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
619 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
620 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
621 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
622 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
623 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
624 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
625 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
627 Math formatting in ODT export
629 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
630 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
632 Advanced topics in ODT export
634 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
635 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
636 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
637 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
638 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
642 * Configuration:: Defining projects
643 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
644 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
645 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
649 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
650 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
651 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
652 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
653 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
654 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
655 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
656 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
660 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
661 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
663 Working with source code
665 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
666 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
667 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
668 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
669 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
670 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
671 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
672 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
673 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
674 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
675 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
676 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
680 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
681 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
683 Using header arguments
685 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
686 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
687 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
688 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
689 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
690 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
692 Specific header arguments
694 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
695 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
696 be collected and handled
697 * file:: Specify a path for file output
698 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
699 directory for code block execution
700 * exports:: Export code and/or results
701 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
702 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
703 files during tangling
704 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
706 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
708 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
709 expansion during tangling
710 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
711 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
712 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
713 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
714 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
715 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
716 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
717 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
718 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
719 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
720 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
724 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
725 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
726 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
727 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
728 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
729 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
730 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
731 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
732 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
733 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
734 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
736 Interaction with other packages
738 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
739 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
743 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
744 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
745 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
746 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
747 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
748 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
749 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
750 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
751 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
752 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
754 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
756 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
757 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
758 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
759 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
763 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
764 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
765 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
770 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
771 @chapter Introduction
775 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
776 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
777 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
778 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
779 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
782 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
786 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
787 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
789 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
790 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
791 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
792 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
793 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
794 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
795 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
796 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
797 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
798 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
799 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
800 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
801 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
804 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
805 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
806 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
808 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
809 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
810 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
812 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
813 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
814 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
815 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
816 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
817 the minor Orgstruct mode.
819 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
820 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
821 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
822 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
826 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
827 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
828 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
829 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
830 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
831 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
832 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
833 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
834 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
839 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
840 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
841 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
842 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
844 @cindex print edition
845 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
846 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
852 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
853 @section Installation
857 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
858 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
859 to @ref{Activation}. To see what version of Org (if any) is part of your
860 Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x load-library RET org} and then @kbd{M-x
863 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
864 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
865 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
866 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
867 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
868 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
869 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
870 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
871 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
874 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
878 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
879 step for this directory:
882 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
885 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
891 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
892 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
899 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
900 @file{install-info} program. The following should correctly install the Info
901 files on most systems, please send a bug report if not@footnote{The output
902 from install-info (if any) is also system dependent. In particular Debian
903 and its derivatives use two different versions of install-info and you may
907 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
908 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
911 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}.
917 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
918 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
919 when Org mode starts.
921 (require 'org-install)
924 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
927 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
931 @cindex global key bindings
932 @cindex key bindings, global
934 To make sure files with extension @file{.org} use Org mode, add the following
935 line to your @file{.emacs} file.
937 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
939 @noindent Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the
940 default in Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in
941 Org buffer with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
943 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
944 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
945 global keys (i.e.@: anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
946 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
949 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
950 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
951 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
952 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
955 @cindex Org mode, turning on
956 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
957 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
961 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
964 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
965 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
966 the file's name is. See also the variable
967 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
969 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
970 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
971 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
972 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
974 (transient-mark-mode 1)
976 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
977 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
978 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
980 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
987 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
988 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
989 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
990 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
991 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
992 moderators have to do.}.
994 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
995 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
996 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
997 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
998 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
999 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1000 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1002 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1004 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1005 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1006 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1008 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1009 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1010 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1011 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1012 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1015 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1018 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1019 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as @code{emacs
1020 -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as shown below.
1023 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1025 ;; activate debugging
1026 (setq debug-on-error t
1030 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1031 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1032 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp"))
1035 (require 'org-install)
1038 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1039 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1043 @item What exactly did you do?
1044 @item What did you expect to happen?
1045 @item What happened instead?
1047 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1049 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1051 @cindex backtrace of an error
1052 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1053 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1054 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1055 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1056 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1060 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1061 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1064 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1067 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1070 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1071 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1073 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1074 document the steps you take.
1076 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1077 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1078 attach it to your bug report.
1081 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1082 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1084 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
1085 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1090 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1094 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1095 meaning are written with all capitals.
1098 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1099 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1102 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing
1103 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1104 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1105 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1106 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1107 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1108 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1109 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1111 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1112 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1114 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1115 @chapter Document structure
1116 @cindex document structure
1117 @cindex structure of document
1119 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1120 edit the structure of the document.
1123 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1124 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1125 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1126 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1127 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1128 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1129 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1130 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1131 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1132 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1133 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1136 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1139 @cindex Outline mode
1141 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1142 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1143 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1144 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1145 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1146 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1147 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1148 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1150 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1153 @cindex outline tree
1154 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1155 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1156 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1158 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1159 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1160 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1161 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1162 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
1165 * Top level headline
1172 * Another top level headline
1175 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1176 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1177 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1179 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1180 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1181 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1182 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1183 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1184 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1186 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1187 @section Visibility cycling
1188 @cindex cycling, visibility
1189 @cindex visibility cycling
1190 @cindex trees, visibility
1191 @cindex show hidden text
1194 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1195 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1196 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1198 @cindex subtree visibility states
1199 @cindex subtree cycling
1200 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1201 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1202 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1204 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1205 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1208 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1209 '-----------------------------------'
1212 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1213 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1214 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1215 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1216 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1217 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1218 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1219 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1221 @cindex global visibility states
1222 @cindex global cycling
1223 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1224 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1225 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1226 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1227 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1228 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1231 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1232 '--------------------------------------'
1235 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1236 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1237 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1239 @cindex show all, command
1240 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1241 Show all, including drawers.
1242 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1243 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1244 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1245 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1246 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1247 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1248 entire subtree of the parent.
1249 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1250 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1251 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1252 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1255 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1258 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1260 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1261 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1262 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1263 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1264 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1265 the previously used indirect buffer.
1266 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1267 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1270 @vindex org-startup-folded
1271 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1272 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1273 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1274 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1276 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1277 OVERVIEW, i.e.@: only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1278 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1279 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1286 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1289 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1291 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1292 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1293 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1296 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1297 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.@: whatever is
1298 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1302 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1304 @cindex motion, between headlines
1305 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1306 @cindex headline navigation
1307 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1310 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1312 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1314 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1315 Next heading same level.
1316 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1317 Previous heading same level.
1318 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1319 Backward to higher level heading.
1320 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1321 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1322 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1323 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1324 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1326 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1327 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1328 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1329 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1330 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1331 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1332 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1334 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1337 @vindex org-goto-interface
1339 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1342 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1343 @section Structure editing
1344 @cindex structure editing
1345 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1346 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1347 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1348 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1349 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1350 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1351 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1352 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1353 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1356 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1357 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1358 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1359 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1360 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1361 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1362 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1363 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1364 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1365 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1366 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.@:
1367 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1368 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1369 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1370 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1371 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1372 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1373 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1374 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1375 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1376 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1377 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1378 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1379 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1381 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1382 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1383 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1384 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1385 to the initial level.
1386 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1387 Promote current heading by one level.
1388 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1389 Demote current heading by one level.
1390 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1391 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1392 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1393 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1394 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1395 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1397 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1398 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1399 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1400 Kill subtree, i.e.@: remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1401 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1402 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1403 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1404 sequential subtrees.
1405 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1406 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1407 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1408 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1409 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1410 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1411 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1412 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1413 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1414 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1415 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1416 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1417 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1418 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1419 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1420 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1421 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1423 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1424 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1425 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1426 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1427 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1428 more details, see the docstring of the command
1429 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1430 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1431 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1432 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
1433 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1434 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1435 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1436 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1437 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1438 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1439 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1440 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1441 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1442 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1443 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1444 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1445 Narrow buffer to current block.
1446 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1447 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1448 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1449 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1450 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1451 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1452 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1453 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1454 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1457 @cindex region, active
1458 @cindex active region
1459 @cindex transient mark mode
1460 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1461 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1462 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1463 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1464 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1465 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1469 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1470 @section Sparse trees
1471 @cindex sparse trees
1472 @cindex trees, sparse
1473 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1474 @cindex occur, command
1476 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1477 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1478 @vindex org-show-siblings
1479 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1480 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1481 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1482 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1483 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1484 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1485 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1486 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1487 and you will see immediately how it works.
1489 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1490 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1493 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1494 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1495 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1496 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1497 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1498 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1499 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1500 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1501 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1502 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1503 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1504 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1505 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1506 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1507 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1508 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1509 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1510 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1515 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1516 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1517 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1518 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1519 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1523 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1524 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1527 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1528 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1530 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1531 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1534 @cindex printing sparse trees
1535 @cindex visible text, printing
1536 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1537 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1538 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1539 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1540 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1541 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1543 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1544 @section Plain lists
1546 @cindex lists, plain
1547 @cindex lists, ordered
1548 @cindex ordered lists
1550 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1551 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1552 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1553 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1555 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1558 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1559 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1560 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1561 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1562 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1563 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1566 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1567 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1568 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1569 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1570 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1571 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1572 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1573 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1574 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1575 list to start with a different value (e.g.@: 20), start the text of the item
1576 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1577 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1578 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1579 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1581 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1582 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1586 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1587 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1588 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1589 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1590 than its bullet/number.
1592 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1593 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1594 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1595 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1596 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1600 ** Lord of the Rings
1601 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1602 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1603 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1604 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1605 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1606 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1608 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1609 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1610 Important actors in this film are:
1611 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1612 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1613 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1617 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1618 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1619 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1620 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1621 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1622 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1623 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1625 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1626 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1627 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1628 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1629 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1630 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1631 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1633 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1634 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1635 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1636 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1637 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1638 to disable them individually.
1641 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1642 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1643 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1644 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1645 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1646 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1647 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1648 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1649 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1650 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1651 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1652 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1653 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1654 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1655 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1656 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1657 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1658 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1659 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1660 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1661 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1662 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1667 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1669 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1670 @kindex S-@key{down}
1673 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1674 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1675 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1676 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1677 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1678 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1679 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1680 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1683 @kindex M-@key{down}
1686 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1687 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1688 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1690 @kindex M-@key{left}
1691 @kindex M-@key{right}
1694 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1695 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1696 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1699 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1700 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1701 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1702 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1703 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1706 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1707 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1708 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1709 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1712 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1713 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1714 consistency in the whole list.
1716 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1717 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1719 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1720 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1721 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1722 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1723 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1724 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1725 active region when calling this, selected text will be changed into an item.
1726 With a prefix argument, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1727 first line already was a list item, any item marker will be removed from the
1728 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1729 converted into a list item.
1732 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1733 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1736 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1737 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1739 @kindex S-@key{left}
1740 @kindex S-@key{right}
1742 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1743 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1744 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1745 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1748 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1749 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1752 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1756 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1759 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1760 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1761 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1762 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1763 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1767 ** This is a headline
1768 Still outside the drawer
1770 This is inside the drawer.
1775 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1776 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1777 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1778 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1779 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1780 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1781 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1782 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1787 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1790 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1793 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1794 @cindex blocks, folding
1795 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1796 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1797 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1798 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1799 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1800 or on a per-file basis by using
1802 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1803 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1805 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1806 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1809 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1813 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1814 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1815 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1816 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e.@: a footnote is
1817 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1818 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1819 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1820 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1823 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1825 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1828 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1829 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1830 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1831 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1832 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1836 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1837 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1840 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1841 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1842 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1843 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1845 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1846 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1847 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1848 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1851 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1852 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1853 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1854 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1857 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1862 The footnote action command.
1864 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1865 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1867 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1868 @vindex org-footnote-section
1869 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1870 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1871 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1872 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1873 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1874 separately into the location determined by the variable
1875 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1877 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1880 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1881 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1882 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1883 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1884 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1885 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1886 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1887 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1888 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1889 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1890 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1891 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1892 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1893 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g.@: sending}
1894 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1895 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1896 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1899 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1900 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1901 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1906 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1907 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1908 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1912 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1913 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1914 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1917 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1918 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1919 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1920 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1922 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1923 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1924 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1925 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1926 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1929 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1930 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1933 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1934 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1935 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1936 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1937 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1938 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1939 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1942 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1945 @cindex editing tables
1947 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1948 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1949 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1952 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1953 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1954 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1955 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1956 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1957 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1960 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1961 @section The built-in table editor
1962 @cindex table editor, built-in
1964 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with @samp{|} as
1965 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
1966 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
1967 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
1968 might look like this:
1971 | Name | Phone | Age |
1972 |-------+-------+-----|
1973 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1974 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1977 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1978 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1979 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1980 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1981 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1982 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1983 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1984 create the above table, you would only type
1991 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1992 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1993 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1995 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1996 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1997 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1998 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1999 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2000 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2001 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2002 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2003 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2004 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2007 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2008 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2009 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2010 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2011 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2012 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2013 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2014 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2015 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2017 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2018 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2019 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2021 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2022 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2023 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2025 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2026 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2029 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2030 Re-align, move to previous field.
2032 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2033 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2034 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2035 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2037 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2038 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2039 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2040 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2042 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2043 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2044 Move the current column left/right.
2046 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2047 Kill the current column.
2049 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2050 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2052 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2053 Move the current row up/down.
2055 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2056 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2058 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2059 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2060 created below the current one.
2062 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2063 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2064 is created above the current line.
2066 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2067 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2070 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2071 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2072 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2073 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2074 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2075 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2076 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2077 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2078 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2079 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2081 @tsubheading{Regions}
2082 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2083 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2084 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2085 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2087 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2088 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2089 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2091 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2092 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2093 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2094 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2095 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2098 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2099 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2100 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2101 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2102 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2103 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2104 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2107 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2108 @cindex formula, in tables
2109 @cindex calculations, in tables
2110 @cindex region, active
2111 @cindex active region
2112 @cindex transient mark mode
2113 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2114 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2115 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2116 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2118 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2119 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2120 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2121 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2122 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2123 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2124 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2125 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2126 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2128 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2129 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2130 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2131 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2132 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2133 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2134 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2135 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2136 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2138 @item M-x org-table-import
2139 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2140 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2141 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2142 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2143 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2144 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2146 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2147 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2148 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2149 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2151 @item M-x org-table-export
2152 @findex org-table-export
2153 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2154 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2155 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2156 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2157 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2158 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2159 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2160 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2161 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2162 detailed description.
2165 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2166 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2170 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2173 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2174 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2176 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2177 @section Column width and alignment
2178 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2179 @cindex alignment in tables
2181 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2182 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2183 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2185 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2186 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2187 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2188 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2189 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2190 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2191 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2195 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2197 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2198 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2199 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2200 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2201 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2206 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2207 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2208 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2209 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2210 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2211 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2214 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2215 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2216 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2217 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2218 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2219 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2220 on a per-file basis with:
2227 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2228 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2229 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2230 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2231 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2233 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2234 automatically when exporting the document.
2236 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2237 @section Column groups
2238 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2240 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2241 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2242 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2243 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2244 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2245 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2246 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2247 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2248 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2249 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2250 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2253 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2254 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2255 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2256 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2257 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2258 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2259 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2260 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2263 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2264 every vertical line you would like to have:
2267 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2268 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2272 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2273 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2275 @cindex minor mode for tables
2277 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2278 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2279 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2280 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2281 example in Message mode, use
2284 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2287 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2288 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2289 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2290 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2291 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2293 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2294 @section The spreadsheet
2295 @cindex calculations, in tables
2296 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2297 @cindex @file{calc} package
2299 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2300 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2301 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2302 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2303 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2304 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2305 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2306 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2307 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2310 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2311 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2312 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2313 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2314 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2315 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2316 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2317 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2318 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2321 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2322 @subsection References
2325 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2326 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2327 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2328 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2329 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2331 @subsubheading Field references
2332 @cindex field references
2333 @cindex references, to fields
2335 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2336 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2337 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2338 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2339 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2340 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2341 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2342 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2343 representation that looks like this:
2345 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2348 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2349 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e.@: the
2350 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2351 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2352 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2353 column from the right.
2355 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2356 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2357 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2358 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2359 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2360 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2361 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2362 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2363 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2364 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2365 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc@. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2366 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2367 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2368 after the third hline in the table.
2370 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2371 i.e. to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2372 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2375 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2376 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2377 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2378 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2379 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2380 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2382 Here are a few examples:
2385 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2386 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2387 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2388 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2389 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2390 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2393 @subsubheading Range references
2394 @cindex range references
2395 @cindex references, to ranges
2397 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2398 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2399 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2400 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2401 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2402 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2405 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2406 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2407 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2408 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2409 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2410 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2413 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2414 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2415 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2416 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2417 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2419 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2420 @cindex field coordinates
2421 @cindex coordinates, of field
2422 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2423 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2425 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2426 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2427 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2428 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2431 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2432 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2433 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2436 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2437 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2438 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2441 @subsubheading Named references
2442 @cindex named references
2443 @cindex references, named
2444 @cindex name, of column or field
2445 @cindex constants, in calculations
2448 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2449 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2450 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2451 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2455 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2459 @vindex constants-unit-system
2460 @pindex constants.el
2461 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2462 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2463 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2464 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2465 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2466 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2467 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2468 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2469 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2470 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2471 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2472 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2473 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2474 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2477 @subsubheading Remote references
2478 @cindex remote references
2479 @cindex references, remote
2480 @cindex references, to a different table
2481 @cindex name, of column or field
2482 @cindex constants, in calculations
2485 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2486 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2489 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2493 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2494 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2495 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2496 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2497 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2500 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2501 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2502 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2503 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2505 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2506 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2507 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2508 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2509 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2510 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2511 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2512 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2513 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2514 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2515 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2517 @cindex format specifier
2518 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2519 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2520 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2521 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2522 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2523 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2524 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2525 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2526 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2529 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2530 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2531 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2532 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2533 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2534 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2535 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2536 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2537 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2542 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2543 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2544 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2545 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2546 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2547 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2548 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2549 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2550 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2554 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2555 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2556 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2557 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2558 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2559 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2560 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2561 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2562 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2563 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2564 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2567 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2570 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2573 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2574 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2576 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2577 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2578 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2580 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
2581 string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
2582 enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
2583 parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
2584 return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
2585 can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
2586 forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
2587 interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
2588 a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
2589 @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
2590 fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
2591 you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
2592 without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
2593 by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
2594 like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2595 embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
2596 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
2599 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2600 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2601 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2603 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2604 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2607 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2608 @subsection Durations and time values
2609 @cindex Duration, computing
2610 @cindex Time, computing
2611 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2613 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2614 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2618 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2619 |---------+----------+----------|
2620 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2621 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2622 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2626 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2627 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2628 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2629 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2630 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2631 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2634 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2635 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2637 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2638 @subsection Field and range formulas
2639 @cindex field formula
2640 @cindex range formula
2641 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2642 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2644 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2645 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2646 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2647 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2648 current field will be replaced with the result.
2651 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2652 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2653 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2654 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2655 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2656 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2657 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2658 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2659 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2660 of cause not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2661 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2663 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2667 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2668 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2669 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2670 it to the current field, and stores it.
2673 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2674 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2675 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2676 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2681 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2682 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2684 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2687 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2688 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2690 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2693 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2694 @subsection Column formulas
2695 @cindex column formula
2696 @cindex formula, for table column
2698 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2699 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2700 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2701 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2702 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2703 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2704 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2706 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2707 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2708 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2709 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2710 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2711 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2712 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2713 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2714 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2715 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2717 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2721 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2722 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2723 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2724 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2725 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g.@: @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2726 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2729 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2730 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2731 @cindex formula editing
2732 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2734 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2735 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2736 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2737 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2738 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2739 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2740 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2741 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2744 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2745 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2746 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2747 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2748 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2749 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2750 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2751 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2752 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2753 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2754 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2756 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2758 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2759 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2760 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2762 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2764 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2765 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2766 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2767 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2768 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2769 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2770 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2771 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2772 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2774 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2775 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2776 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2777 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2778 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2779 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2780 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2781 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2782 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2783 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2784 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2785 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2786 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2787 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2788 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2790 @kindex S-@key{down}
2791 @kindex S-@key{left}
2792 @kindex S-@key{right}
2793 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2794 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2795 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2796 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2797 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2798 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2799 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2800 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2801 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2802 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2804 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2805 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2807 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2809 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2813 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2814 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2815 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2816 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2817 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2820 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2821 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2822 recalculation commands in the table.
2824 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2825 @cindex formula debugging
2826 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2827 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2828 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2829 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2830 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2831 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2832 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2834 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2835 @subsection Updating the table
2836 @cindex recomputing table fields
2837 @cindex updating, table
2839 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2840 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2841 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2843 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2847 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2848 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2849 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2855 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2856 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2858 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2859 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2860 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2861 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2862 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2863 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2864 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2865 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2866 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2867 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2871 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2872 @subsection Advanced features
2874 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2875 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2876 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2877 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2878 special marking characters.
2881 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2882 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2883 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2884 change all marks in the region.
2887 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2888 makes use of these features:
2892 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2893 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2894 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2895 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2896 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2897 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2898 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2899 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2900 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2901 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2902 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2903 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2904 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2905 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2906 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2910 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2911 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2912 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2913 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2916 @cindex marking characters, tables
2917 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2920 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2921 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2923 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2924 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2925 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2926 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2928 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2931 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2932 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2933 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2934 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2937 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2938 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2939 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2940 lines will be left alone by this command.
2942 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2943 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2944 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2946 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2947 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2950 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2951 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2954 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2955 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2956 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2961 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2962 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2963 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2964 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2965 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2966 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2967 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2968 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2969 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2970 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2971 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2975 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2977 @cindex graph, in tables
2978 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2981 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2982 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2983 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2984 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2985 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2989 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2990 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2991 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2992 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2993 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2994 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2995 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2996 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3000 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3001 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3002 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3003 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3004 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3005 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3007 @subsubheading Plot Options
3011 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3014 Specify the title of the plot.
3017 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3020 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3021 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3022 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3026 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3029 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3030 (e.g.@: @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3031 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3034 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3037 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3041 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3044 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3045 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3048 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3049 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3052 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3053 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3054 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3055 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3056 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3060 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3064 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3065 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3068 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3069 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3070 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3071 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3072 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3073 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3074 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3075 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3078 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3079 @section Link format
3081 @cindex format, of links
3083 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3084 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3087 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3091 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3092 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3093 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3094 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3095 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3096 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3097 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3098 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3101 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3102 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3103 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3104 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3105 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3106 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3107 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3109 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3110 @section Internal links
3111 @cindex internal links
3112 @cindex links, internal
3113 @cindex targets, for links
3115 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3116 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3117 current file. The most important case is a link like
3118 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3119 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3120 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3121 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3124 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3125 lead to a text search in the current file.
3127 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3128 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3129 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3130 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3131 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3132 comment line. For example
3138 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3139 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3140 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3141 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3144 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3145 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3146 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3147 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3148 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3149 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3150 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3152 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3153 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3154 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3158 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3161 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3162 @subsection Radio targets
3163 @cindex radio targets
3164 @cindex targets, radio
3165 @cindex links, radio targets
3167 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3168 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3169 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3170 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3171 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3172 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3173 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3174 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3175 cursor on or at a target.
3177 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3178 @section External links
3179 @cindex links, external
3180 @cindex external links
3181 @cindex links, external
3189 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3191 @cindex USENET links
3196 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3197 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3198 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3199 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3200 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3203 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3204 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3205 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3206 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3207 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3208 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3209 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3210 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3211 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3212 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3213 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3214 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3215 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3216 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3217 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3218 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3219 will be queried to create it.}
3220 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3221 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3222 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3223 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3224 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3225 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3226 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3227 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3228 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3229 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3230 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3231 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3232 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3233 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3234 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3235 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3236 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3237 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3238 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3239 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3240 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3241 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3242 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3243 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3246 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3248 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3249 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3250 format}), for example:
3253 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3257 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3258 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3259 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3261 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3263 @cindex square brackets, around links
3264 @cindex plain text external links
3265 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3266 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3267 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3268 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3270 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3271 @section Handling links
3272 @cindex links, handling
3274 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3275 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3278 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3279 @cindex storing links
3280 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3281 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3282 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3283 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3286 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3287 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3288 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3289 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3290 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3291 timestamp in the headline.}.
3293 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3294 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3295 @cindex property, ID
3296 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3297 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3298 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3299 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3300 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3301 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3302 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3305 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3306 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3307 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3308 constructed from the author and the subject.
3310 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3311 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3313 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3314 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3317 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3318 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3319 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3320 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3321 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3324 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3325 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3326 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3327 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3328 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3329 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3330 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3333 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3334 entry referenced by the current line.
3337 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3338 @cindex link completion
3339 @cindex completion, of links
3340 @cindex inserting links
3341 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3342 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3343 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3344 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3345 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3346 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3347 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3348 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3349 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3350 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3351 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3352 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3353 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3354 becomes the default description.
3356 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3357 All links stored during the
3358 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3359 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3361 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3362 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3363 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3364 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3365 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3366 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3367 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3368 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3369 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3371 @cindex file name completion
3372 @cindex completion, of file names
3373 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3374 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3375 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3376 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3377 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3378 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3379 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3380 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3382 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3383 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3384 link and description parts of the link.
3386 @cindex following links
3387 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3388 @vindex org-file-apps
3389 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3390 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3391 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3392 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3393 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3394 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3395 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3396 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3397 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3398 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3399 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3400 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3401 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3402 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3403 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3404 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3407 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3408 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3415 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3416 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3420 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3421 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3422 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3423 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3425 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3426 @cindex inlining images
3427 @cindex images, inlining
3428 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3429 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3430 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3431 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3432 images that have no description part in the link, i.e.@: images that will also
3433 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3434 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3435 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3436 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3437 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3438 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3440 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3441 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3443 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3444 @cindex links, returning to
3445 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3446 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3447 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3448 previously recorded positions.
3450 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3451 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3452 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3453 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3454 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3455 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3457 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3459 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3460 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3464 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3465 @section Using links outside Org
3467 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3468 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3469 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3473 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3474 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3477 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3478 @section Link abbreviations
3479 @cindex link abbreviations
3480 @cindex abbreviation, links
3482 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3483 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3484 abbreviated link looks like this
3487 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3491 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3492 where the tag is optional.
3493 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3494 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3495 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3496 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3500 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3501 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3502 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3503 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3504 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3505 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3509 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3510 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3511 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3512 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3514 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3515 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3516 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3517 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3518 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3519 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3520 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3522 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3523 can define them in the file with
3527 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3528 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3532 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3533 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3534 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
3535 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3536 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3538 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3539 @section Search options in file links
3540 @cindex search option in file links
3541 @cindex file links, searching
3543 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3544 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3545 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3546 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3547 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3548 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3549 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3550 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3552 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3553 link, together with an explanation:
3556 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3557 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3558 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3559 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3560 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3567 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3568 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3569 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3570 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3573 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3575 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3577 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3578 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3579 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3580 sparse tree with the matches.
3581 @c If the target file is a directory,
3582 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3585 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3586 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3587 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3588 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3590 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3591 @section Custom Searches
3592 @cindex custom search strings
3593 @cindex search strings, custom
3595 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3596 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3597 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3598 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3599 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3602 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3603 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3604 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3605 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3606 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3607 to be added to the hook variables
3608 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3609 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3610 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3611 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3612 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3614 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3618 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3619 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3620 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3621 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3622 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3623 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3624 item emerged is always present.
3626 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3627 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3628 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3631 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3632 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3633 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3634 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3635 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3636 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3639 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3640 @section Basic TODO functionality
3642 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3643 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3646 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3650 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3653 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3654 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3655 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3658 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3659 '--------------------------------'
3662 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3663 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3665 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3666 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3667 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3668 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3671 @kindex S-@key{right}
3672 @kindex S-@key{left}
3673 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3674 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3675 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3676 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3677 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3678 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3679 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3680 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3681 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3682 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3683 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3684 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3685 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3686 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3687 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3688 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3689 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3690 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3691 both un-done and done.
3692 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3693 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3694 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3695 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3696 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3697 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3698 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3699 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3703 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3704 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3705 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3707 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3708 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3709 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3711 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3712 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3713 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3714 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3715 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3718 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3719 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3722 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3723 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3724 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3725 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3726 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3727 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3728 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3731 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3732 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3733 @cindex TODO workflow
3734 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3736 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3737 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3738 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3742 (setq org-todo-keywords
3743 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3746 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3747 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3748 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3750 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3751 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3752 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3753 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3754 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3755 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3756 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3757 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3758 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3759 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3760 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3762 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3763 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3765 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3766 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3768 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3769 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3770 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3771 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3772 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3773 be set up like this:
3776 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3779 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3780 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3781 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3782 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3783 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3784 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3785 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3786 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3787 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3788 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3789 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3790 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3791 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3792 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3794 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3795 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3796 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3798 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3799 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3800 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3801 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3802 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3806 (setq org-todo-keywords
3807 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3808 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3809 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3812 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3813 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3814 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3815 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3816 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3817 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3818 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3821 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3822 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3823 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3824 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3825 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3826 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3827 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3828 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3829 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3830 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3831 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3832 @kindex S-@key{right}
3833 @kindex S-@key{left}
3836 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3837 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3838 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3839 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3840 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3843 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3844 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3846 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3847 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3848 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3849 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3852 (setq org-todo-keywords
3853 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3854 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3855 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3858 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3859 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3860 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3861 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3862 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3863 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3864 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3865 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3867 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3868 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3869 @cindex keyword options
3870 @cindex per-file keywords
3875 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3876 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3877 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3878 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3879 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3883 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3885 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3886 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3888 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3891 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3895 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3899 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3901 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3902 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3904 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3905 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3906 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3907 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3908 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3909 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3910 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3911 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3912 for the current buffer.}.
3914 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3915 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3916 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3918 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3919 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3920 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3921 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3922 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3923 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3924 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3925 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3926 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3930 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3931 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3932 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3936 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3937 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3938 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3939 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3940 foreground or a background color.
3942 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3943 @subsection TODO dependencies
3944 @cindex TODO dependencies
3945 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3947 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3948 @cindex property, ORDERED
3949 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3950 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3951 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3952 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3953 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3954 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3955 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3956 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3957 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3961 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3970 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3971 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3975 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
3976 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3977 @cindex property, ORDERED
3978 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3979 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3980 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3981 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3982 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3983 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
3984 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3987 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3988 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3989 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3990 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3992 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3993 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3994 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3995 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3996 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3997 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3999 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4000 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4001 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4004 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4005 @section Progress logging
4006 @cindex progress logging
4007 @cindex logging, of progress
4009 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4010 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4011 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4012 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4013 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4017 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4018 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4019 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4022 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4023 @subsection Closing items
4025 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4026 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4027 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4030 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4034 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4035 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4036 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4037 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4038 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4039 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4042 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4046 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4047 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4049 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4050 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4051 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4052 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4054 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4055 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4056 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4058 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4059 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4060 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4061 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4062 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4063 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4064 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4065 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4066 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4067 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4068 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
4069 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
4070 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4071 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4073 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4074 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4075 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4076 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4080 (setq org-todo-keywords
4081 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4084 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4085 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4088 @vindex org-log-done
4089 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4090 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4091 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4092 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4093 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4094 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4095 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4096 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4097 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4098 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4099 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4100 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4101 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4102 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4103 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4106 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4109 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4112 @cindex property, LOGGING
4113 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4114 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4115 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4116 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4117 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4118 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4121 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4123 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4125 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4127 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4129 * TODO No logging at all
4135 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4136 @subsection Tracking your habits
4139 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4140 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4144 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4147 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4149 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4151 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4152 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4153 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4154 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4156 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4157 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4158 three days, but at most every two days.
4160 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
4161 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not
4162 enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
4166 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4167 actual habit with some history:
4171 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4172 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4173 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4174 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4175 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4176 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4177 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4178 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4179 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4180 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4181 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4184 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4188 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4189 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4190 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4191 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4192 after four days have elapsed.
4194 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4195 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4196 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4197 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4201 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4203 If the task could have been done on that day.
4205 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4207 If the task was overdue on that day.
4210 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4211 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4212 the current day falls in the graph.
4214 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4215 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4218 @item org-habit-graph-column
4219 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4220 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4221 titles brief and to the point.
4222 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4223 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4224 @item org-habit-following-days
4225 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4226 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4227 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4231 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4232 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4233 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4234 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4236 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4240 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4241 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4242 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4245 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4249 @vindex org-priority-faces
4250 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4251 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4252 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4253 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4254 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4255 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4257 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4263 @findex org-priority
4264 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4265 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4266 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4267 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4268 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4270 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4271 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4272 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4273 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4274 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4275 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4276 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4279 @vindex org-highest-priority
4280 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4281 @vindex org-default-priority
4282 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4283 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4284 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4285 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4286 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4289 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4294 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4295 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4296 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4297 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4299 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4300 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4301 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4302 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4303 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4304 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4305 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4306 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4307 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4310 * Organize Party [33%]
4311 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4315 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4318 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4319 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4320 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4321 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4324 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4325 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4326 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4327 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4328 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4332 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4334 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4338 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4339 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4342 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4343 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4344 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4345 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4347 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4351 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4352 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4355 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4359 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4360 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4361 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4362 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4363 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4364 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4365 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4366 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4367 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4368 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4370 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4373 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4374 - [-] call people [1/3]
4379 - [ ] think about what music to play
4380 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4383 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4384 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4385 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4388 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4389 @cindex checkbox statistics
4390 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4391 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4392 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4393 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4394 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4395 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4396 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4397 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4398 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4399 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4400 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4401 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4402 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4403 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4404 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4405 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4406 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4407 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4408 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4410 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4411 @cindex checkbox blocking
4412 @cindex property, ORDERED
4413 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4414 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4415 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4417 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4420 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4421 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4422 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4423 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4424 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4425 considered to be an intermediate state.
4426 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4427 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4428 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4432 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4433 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4434 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4436 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4437 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4439 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4441 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4442 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4443 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4444 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4445 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4446 @cindex property, ORDERED
4447 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4448 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4449 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4450 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4451 for better visibility, customize the variable
4452 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4453 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4454 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4455 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4456 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4457 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4458 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4459 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4462 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4465 @cindex headline tagging
4466 @cindex matching, tags
4467 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4469 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4470 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4473 @vindex org-tag-faces
4474 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4475 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4476 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4477 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4478 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4479 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4480 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4481 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4484 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4485 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4486 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4489 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4490 @section Tag inheritance
4491 @cindex tag inheritance
4492 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4493 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4495 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4496 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4497 well. For example, in the list
4500 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4501 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4502 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4506 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4507 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4508 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4509 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4510 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4511 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4512 changes in the line.}:
4516 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4520 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4521 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4522 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4523 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4524 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4526 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4527 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4528 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4529 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4530 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4531 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4532 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4533 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4535 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4536 @section Setting tags
4537 @cindex setting tags
4538 @cindex tags, setting
4541 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4542 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4543 also a special command for inserting tags:
4546 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4547 @cindex completion, of tags
4548 @vindex org-tags-column
4549 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4550 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4551 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4552 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4553 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4554 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4555 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4556 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4557 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4560 @vindex org-tag-alist
4561 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4562 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4563 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4564 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4565 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4569 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4570 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4573 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4574 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4575 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4581 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4582 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4583 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4584 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4585 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4586 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4592 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4593 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4594 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4595 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4596 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4597 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4598 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4599 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4603 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4606 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4607 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4610 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4613 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4614 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4615 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4618 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4621 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4624 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4625 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4629 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4633 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4636 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4637 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4639 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4640 these lines to activate any changes.
4643 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4644 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4645 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4646 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4650 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4651 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4652 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4654 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4657 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4658 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4659 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4660 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4661 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4666 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4667 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4668 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4671 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4672 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4673 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4677 Clear all tags for this line.
4680 Accept the modified set.
4682 Abort without installing changes.
4684 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4686 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4687 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4689 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4690 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4695 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4696 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4697 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4698 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4699 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4700 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4701 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4702 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4704 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4705 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4706 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4707 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4708 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4709 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4710 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4711 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4712 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4713 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4714 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4716 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4717 @section Tag searches
4718 @cindex tag searches
4719 @cindex searching for tags
4721 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4722 information into special lists.
4725 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4726 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4727 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4728 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4729 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4730 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4731 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4732 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4733 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4734 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4735 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4738 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4739 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4740 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4741 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4742 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4743 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4744 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4747 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4748 @chapter Properties and columns
4751 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4752 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4753 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4755 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4756 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4757 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4758 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4759 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4760 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4761 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4762 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4763 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4765 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4766 (@pxref{Column view}).
4769 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4770 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4771 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4772 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4773 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4774 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4777 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4778 @section Property syntax
4779 @cindex property syntax
4780 @cindex drawer, for properties
4782 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4783 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4784 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4785 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4786 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4791 *** Goldberg Variations
4793 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4794 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4796 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4801 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4802 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4803 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4805 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4806 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4807 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4808 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4809 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4810 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4811 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4816 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4817 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4821 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4822 file, use a line like
4823 @cindex property, _ALL
4826 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4829 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4830 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4831 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4834 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4835 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4838 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4839 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4840 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4848 *** Goldberg Variations
4850 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4851 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4853 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4858 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4860 @vindex org-global-properties
4861 Property values set with the global variable
4862 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4866 The following commands help to work with properties:
4869 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4870 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4871 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4872 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4873 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4874 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4875 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4876 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
4877 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4878 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4879 information like deadlines.
4880 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4881 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4882 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4883 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4884 can be inserted using completion.
4885 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4886 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4887 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4888 Remove a property from the current entry.
4889 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4890 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4891 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4892 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4893 nearest column format definition.
4896 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4897 @section Special properties
4898 @cindex properties, special
4900 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
4901 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4902 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4903 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4904 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4905 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4907 @cindex property, special, TODO
4908 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4909 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4910 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4911 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4912 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4913 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4914 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4915 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4916 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4917 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4918 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4919 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4920 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4921 @cindex property, special, FILE
4923 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4924 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4925 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4926 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4927 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4928 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4929 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4930 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4931 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4932 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4933 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4934 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
4935 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4936 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4937 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
4940 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4941 @section Property searches
4942 @cindex properties, searching
4943 @cindex searching, of properties
4945 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4946 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4948 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4949 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4950 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4951 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4952 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4953 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4954 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4955 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4956 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4957 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4958 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4961 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4964 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4969 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4970 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4971 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4972 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
4973 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4976 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4977 @section Property Inheritance
4978 @cindex properties, inheritance
4979 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4981 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4982 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
4983 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4984 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
4985 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4986 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4987 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4988 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4989 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4990 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4991 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4992 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
4993 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4995 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4996 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4998 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5001 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5002 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5003 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5004 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5005 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5007 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5008 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5009 applies to the entire subtree.
5011 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5012 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5013 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5015 @cindex property, LOGGING
5016 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5017 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5020 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5021 @section Column view
5023 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5024 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5025 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5026 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5027 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5028 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5029 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5030 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5031 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5032 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5033 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5034 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5035 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5038 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5039 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5040 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5043 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5044 @subsection Defining columns
5045 @cindex column view, for properties
5046 @cindex properties, column view
5048 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5049 done by defining a column format line.
5052 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5053 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5056 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5057 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5059 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5063 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5066 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5067 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5070 ** Top node for columns view
5072 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5076 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5077 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5078 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5079 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5080 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5081 deeper part of the tree.
5083 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5084 @subsubsection Column attributes
5085 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5086 definition looks like this:
5089 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5093 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5094 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5097 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5098 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5099 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5100 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5101 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5102 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5104 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5105 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5106 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5107 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5108 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5109 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5110 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5111 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5112 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5113 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5114 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5115 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5116 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5117 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5118 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5119 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5120 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5121 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5122 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5123 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5127 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5128 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5129 same summary information.
5131 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5132 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5133 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5134 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5135 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5136 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5138 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5139 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5140 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5141 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5142 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5143 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5144 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5145 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5147 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5151 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5152 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5153 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5154 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5155 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5159 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5160 item itself, i.e.@: of the headline. You probably always should start the
5161 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5162 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5163 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5164 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5165 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5166 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5167 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5168 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5169 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5170 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5171 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
5174 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5175 @subsection Using column view
5178 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5179 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5180 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5181 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5182 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5183 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5184 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5185 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5186 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5187 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5188 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5189 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5190 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5191 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5192 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5194 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5196 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5197 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5198 Move through the column view from field to field.
5199 @kindex S-@key{left}
5200 @kindex S-@key{right}
5201 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5202 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5203 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5205 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5206 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5207 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5208 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5209 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5210 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5211 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5212 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5213 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5214 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5215 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5216 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5217 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5218 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5219 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5220 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5221 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5222 current column view.
5223 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5224 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5225 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5226 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5227 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5228 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5229 Delete the current column.
5232 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5233 @subsection Capturing column view
5235 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5236 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5237 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5238 of this block looks like this:
5240 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5243 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5248 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5252 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5253 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5254 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5255 capture, you can use 4 values:
5256 @cindex property, ID
5258 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5259 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5260 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5261 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5262 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5263 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5264 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5265 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5268 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5269 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5271 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5273 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5274 @item :skip-empty-rows
5275 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5276 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5281 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5284 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5285 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5286 for the scope or ID of the view.
5287 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5288 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5289 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5290 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5291 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5292 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5296 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5297 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5298 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5299 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5301 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5302 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5303 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5304 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5305 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5306 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5307 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5309 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5310 @section The Property API
5311 @cindex properties, API
5312 @cindex API, for properties
5314 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5315 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5316 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5319 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5320 @chapter Dates and times
5326 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5327 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5328 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5329 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5330 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5331 is used in a much wider sense.
5334 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5335 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5336 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5337 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5338 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5339 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5340 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5344 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5345 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5347 @cindex ranges, time
5352 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5353 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5354 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5355 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5356 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5357 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5358 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5359 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5360 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5361 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5364 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5367 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5368 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5369 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5370 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5373 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5374 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5377 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5378 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5379 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5380 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5381 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5382 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5385 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5388 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5389 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5390 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5391 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5392 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5393 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5394 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5395 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5396 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5397 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5398 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5399 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5400 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5401 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5402 example with optional time
5405 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5406 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5409 @item Time/Date range
5412 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5413 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5414 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5417 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5418 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5421 @item Inactive timestamp
5422 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5423 @cindex inactive timestamp
5424 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5425 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5426 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5429 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5434 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5435 @section Creating timestamps
5436 @cindex creating timestamps
5437 @cindex timestamps, creating
5439 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5440 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5444 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5445 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5446 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5447 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5448 succession, a time range is inserted.
5450 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5451 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5458 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5459 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5460 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5461 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5464 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5466 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5467 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5469 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5470 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5471 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5474 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5475 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5476 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5478 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5479 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5480 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5482 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5483 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5484 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5485 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5486 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5487 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5488 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5489 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5490 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5492 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5493 @cindex evaluate time range
5494 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5495 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5496 the following column).
5501 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5502 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5505 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5506 @subsection The date/time prompt
5507 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5508 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5510 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5511 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5512 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5513 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5514 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5515 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5516 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5517 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5518 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5519 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5520 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5521 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5522 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5523 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5524 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5525 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5526 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5527 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5529 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5530 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5534 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5535 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5536 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5537 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5538 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5539 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5540 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5541 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5542 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5543 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5544 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5545 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5546 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5547 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5550 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5551 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5552 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5553 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5554 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5555 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5556 the Nth such day, e.g.@:
5561 +4d @result{} four days from today
5562 +4 @result{} same as above
5563 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5564 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5565 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5568 @vindex parse-time-months
5569 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5570 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5571 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5572 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5574 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5575 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5576 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5577 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5578 read the docstring of the variable
5579 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5581 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5582 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5583 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5587 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5588 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5589 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5592 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5593 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5594 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5595 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5596 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5597 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5598 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5599 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5600 from the minibuffer:
5607 @kindex S-@key{right}
5608 @kindex S-@key{left}
5609 @kindex S-@key{down}
5611 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5612 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5615 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5616 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5617 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5618 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5619 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5620 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5621 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5624 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5625 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5626 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5627 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5628 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5629 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5630 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5632 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5633 @subsection Custom time format
5634 @cindex custom date/time format
5635 @cindex time format, custom
5636 @cindex date format, custom
5638 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5639 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5640 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5641 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5642 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5643 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5644 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5647 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5648 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5652 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5653 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5654 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5655 following consequences:
5658 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5661 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5662 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5663 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5664 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5665 time will be changed by one minute.
5667 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5668 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5670 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5671 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5672 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5674 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5675 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5676 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5680 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5681 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5683 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5687 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5689 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5690 to be finished on that date.
5692 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5693 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5694 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5695 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5696 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5697 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5700 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5701 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5702 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5705 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5706 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5707 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5710 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5712 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5715 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5716 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5717 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5718 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5719 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5720 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.@:
5721 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5724 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5725 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5729 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5730 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5731 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5732 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5733 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5734 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5735 want to start working on an action item.
5738 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5739 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5740 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5741 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5743 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5745 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5746 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5747 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5751 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5752 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5755 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5756 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5758 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5759 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5760 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5765 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5766 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5767 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5768 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5769 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5770 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5771 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5774 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5775 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5776 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5777 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5778 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5779 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5780 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5781 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5784 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5787 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5788 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5789 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5790 schedule the marked item.
5792 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5793 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5794 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5795 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5796 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5797 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5798 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5799 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5801 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5802 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5804 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5805 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5808 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5809 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g. +1d will set
5810 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5811 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5813 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5814 @subsection Repeated tasks
5815 @cindex tasks, repeated
5816 @cindex repeated tasks
5818 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5819 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5820 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5822 ** TODO Pay the rent
5823 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5826 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5827 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5828 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5829 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5830 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5832 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5833 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5834 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5835 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5836 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5837 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5838 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5839 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5840 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5841 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5842 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5843 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5844 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5845 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5846 switch the date like this:
5849 ** TODO Pay the rent
5850 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5853 @vindex org-log-repeat
5854 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5855 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5856 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5857 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5858 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5860 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5861 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5864 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5865 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5866 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5867 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5868 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5869 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5870 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5871 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5872 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5876 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5877 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5878 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5879 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5880 and marked it done on Saturday.
5881 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5882 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5883 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5887 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5888 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5890 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5891 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5892 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5895 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5896 @section Clocking work time
5897 @cindex clocking time
5898 @cindex time clocking
5900 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5901 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5902 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5903 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5904 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5905 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5906 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5908 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5910 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5911 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5913 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5914 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5915 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5916 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5920 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5921 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5922 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5925 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5926 @subsection Clocking commands
5929 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5930 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5931 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
5932 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5933 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5934 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5935 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5936 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
5937 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
5938 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
5939 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5940 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5941 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5942 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5943 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5944 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5945 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5946 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5947 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5948 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5949 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5950 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5951 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5952 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5953 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5954 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5955 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5956 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5957 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5958 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5959 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5960 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5961 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5962 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5964 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
5965 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5966 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5967 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5968 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5969 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5970 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5971 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5972 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5973 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5974 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5977 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5978 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5979 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5980 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5981 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
5982 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps at the same
5983 time so that duration keeps the same.
5984 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
5985 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5986 if it is running in this same item.
5987 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
5988 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5989 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5990 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
5991 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
5992 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
5993 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
5994 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5995 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
5996 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
5997 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
5998 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
5999 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6003 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6004 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6005 worked on or closed during a day.
6007 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6008 @subsection The clock table
6009 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6010 @cindex report, of clocked time
6012 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6013 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6014 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6017 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6018 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6019 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6020 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6021 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6022 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6023 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6024 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6025 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6026 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6027 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6028 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6029 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6030 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6031 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6032 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6033 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6037 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6038 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6040 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6042 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6046 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6047 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6048 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6049 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6051 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6054 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6055 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6056 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6057 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6058 file @r{the full current buffer}
6059 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6060 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6061 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6062 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6063 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6064 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6065 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6066 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6067 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6069 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6070 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6071 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6072 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6073 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6074 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6075 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6076 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6077 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6078 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6079 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6080 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6081 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6082 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6083 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6084 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6085 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6086 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6089 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6090 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6091 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6093 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6094 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6095 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6096 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6097 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6098 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6099 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6100 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6101 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6102 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6103 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6104 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6105 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6106 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6107 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6108 @r{property will get its own column.}
6109 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6110 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6111 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6112 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6113 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6114 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6116 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6117 day, you could write
6119 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6123 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6124 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6125 only to fit it into the manual.}
6127 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6128 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6131 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6133 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6136 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6139 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6143 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6144 @subsection Resolving idle time
6145 @cindex resolve idle time
6147 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6148 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6149 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6150 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6151 applying it to another one.
6153 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6154 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6155 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6156 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6157 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6158 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6159 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
6160 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
6161 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
6162 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
6163 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
6164 choices to correct the discrepancy:
6168 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6169 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6170 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6172 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6173 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6174 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6176 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6177 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6179 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6180 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6181 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6183 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6184 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6185 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6186 log with an empty entry.
6189 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6190 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6191 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6192 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6193 the next task you clock in on.
6195 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6196 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6197 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6198 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6199 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6201 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6202 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6203 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6204 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6205 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6206 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6208 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6209 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
6211 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6212 @section Effort estimates
6213 @cindex effort estimates
6215 @cindex property, Effort
6216 @vindex org-effort-property
6217 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6218 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6219 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6220 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6221 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6222 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6223 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6224 for an entry with the following commands:
6227 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6228 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6229 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6230 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6231 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6232 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6235 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6236 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6237 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6238 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6242 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6243 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6247 @vindex org-global-properties
6248 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6249 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6250 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6251 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6252 setup may be advised.
6254 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6255 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6256 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6257 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6259 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6260 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6261 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6262 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6263 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6264 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6265 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6266 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6267 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6269 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6270 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6271 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6272 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6274 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6275 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6276 @cindex relative timer
6278 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6279 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6280 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6283 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6284 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6285 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6287 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6288 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6289 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6290 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6291 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6293 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6296 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6297 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6298 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6299 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6301 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6302 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6303 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6304 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6305 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6306 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6307 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6308 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6309 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6310 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6311 not started at exactly the right moment.
6314 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6315 @section Countdown timer
6316 @cindex Countdown timer
6320 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6321 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6323 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6324 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6325 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6328 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6329 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6332 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6333 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6334 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6335 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6336 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6337 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6340 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6341 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6342 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6343 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6344 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6345 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6348 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6352 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6353 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6354 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6355 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6356 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6358 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6359 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6361 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6363 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6364 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6365 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6366 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6368 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6369 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6370 does enhance it with templates and more.
6373 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6374 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6375 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6378 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6379 @subsection Setting up capture
6381 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6382 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6383 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6385 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6387 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6388 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6391 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6392 @subsection Using capture
6395 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6396 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6397 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6399 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6400 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6401 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6402 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6404 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6405 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6406 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6407 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6408 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6410 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6411 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6412 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6413 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6414 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6415 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6416 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6418 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6419 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6423 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6424 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6425 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6426 rather than to the current date.
6428 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6433 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6434 template in the usual way.
6435 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6436 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6439 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6440 @subsection Capture templates
6441 @cindex templates, for Capture
6443 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6444 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6445 through the customize interface.
6449 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6452 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6453 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6454 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6455 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6456 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6460 (setq org-capture-templates
6461 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6462 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6463 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6464 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6467 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6471 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6475 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6476 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6477 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6478 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6479 place where you started the capture process.
6481 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6482 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6486 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6487 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6491 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6492 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6495 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6496 @subsubsection Template elements
6498 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6499 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6503 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6504 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6505 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6506 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6507 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6508 prefix key, for example
6510 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6512 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6513 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6516 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6520 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6523 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6524 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6526 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6527 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6529 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6532 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6533 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6534 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6536 Text to be inserted as it is.
6540 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6541 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6542 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6543 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6544 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6545 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6546 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6550 @item (file "path/to/file")
6551 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6553 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6554 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6556 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6557 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6559 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6560 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6562 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6563 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6565 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6566 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6568 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6569 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6571 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6572 A function to find the right location in the file.
6575 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6577 @item (function function-finding-location)
6578 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6583 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6584 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6585 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6586 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6587 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6591 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6592 Recognized properties are:
6595 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6596 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6597 Setting this property will change that.
6599 @item :immediate-finish
6600 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6601 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6602 information that can be added automatically.
6605 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6606 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6609 Start the clock in this item.
6612 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6615 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6616 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6617 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6618 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6621 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6622 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6624 @item :table-line-pos
6625 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6626 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6627 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6631 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6632 buffer again after capture is completed.
6636 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6637 @subsubsection Template expansion
6639 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6640 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6641 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6644 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6645 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6646 %<...> @r{the result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6647 %t @r{timestamp, date only.}
6648 %T @r{timestamp with date and time.}
6649 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6650 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6651 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6652 @r{region is active.}
6653 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6654 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6655 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6656 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6657 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task.}
6658 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task.}
6659 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6660 %f @r{file visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6661 %F @r{full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6662 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6663 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6664 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6665 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6666 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6667 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6668 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6669 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6670 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6671 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6672 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6673 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6677 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6678 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6679 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6680 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6683 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6685 Link type | Available keywords
6686 ------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6687 bbdb | %:name %:company
6688 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6689 vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6690 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6691 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6692 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6693 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6694 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6695 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6696 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6698 info | %:file %:node
6703 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6706 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6710 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6711 @section Attachments
6714 @vindex org-attach-directory
6715 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6716 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6717 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6718 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6719 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6720 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6721 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6722 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6723 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6724 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6725 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6726 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6727 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6729 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6730 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6731 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6734 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6738 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6739 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6740 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6741 to select a command:
6744 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6745 @vindex org-attach-method
6746 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6747 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6748 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6754 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6755 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6757 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6758 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6760 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6761 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6762 attachments yourself.
6764 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6765 @vindex org-file-apps
6766 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6767 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6768 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6769 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6771 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6772 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6774 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6775 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6777 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6778 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6780 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6781 Select and delete a single attachment.
6783 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6784 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6785 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6787 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6788 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6789 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6790 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6792 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6793 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6794 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6795 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6799 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6804 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6805 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6806 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6807 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6808 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6809 information. Here is just an example:
6812 (setq org-feed-alist
6814 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6815 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6819 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6820 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6821 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6822 the following command is used:
6825 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6827 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6829 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6830 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6833 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6834 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6835 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6836 list of drawers in that file:
6839 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6842 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6843 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6845 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6846 @section Protocols for external access
6847 @cindex protocols, for external access
6850 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6851 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6852 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6853 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6854 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6855 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6856 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6857 documentation and setup instructions.
6859 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6860 @section Refiling notes
6861 @cindex refiling notes
6863 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6864 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6865 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6866 process, you can use the following special command:
6869 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6870 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6871 @vindex org-refile-targets
6872 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6873 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6874 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6875 @vindex org-log-refile
6876 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6877 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6878 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6879 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6880 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6882 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6883 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6884 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6885 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6886 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6887 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6888 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6889 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6890 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6891 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6892 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
6893 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6894 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6895 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6896 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6897 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6899 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6900 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6901 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6902 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
6903 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6906 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6910 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6911 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6912 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6913 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6916 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6917 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6918 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6919 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6923 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6924 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6927 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6928 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6929 @cindex external archiving
6931 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6935 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
6936 @vindex org-archive-location
6937 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6938 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6939 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
6940 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6941 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6942 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6943 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6944 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6947 @cindex archive locations
6948 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6949 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6950 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6951 see the documentation string of the variable
6952 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6953 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6954 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6955 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6956 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6957 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6958 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6959 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6963 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6966 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6968 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6969 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6970 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6972 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6973 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6974 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6975 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6976 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6980 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6981 @subsection Internal archiving
6983 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6984 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6986 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6987 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6990 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6991 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6992 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6993 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6994 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6995 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6997 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6998 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6999 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7000 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7002 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7003 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7004 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7005 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7006 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7007 temporarily included.
7009 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7010 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7011 is. Configure the details using the variable
7012 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7014 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7015 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7016 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7019 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7022 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7023 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7024 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7026 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7027 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7028 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7029 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7030 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7031 level 1 trees will be checked.
7032 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7033 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7034 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7035 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7036 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7037 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7038 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7043 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7044 @chapter Agenda views
7045 @cindex agenda views
7047 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7048 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7049 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7050 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7051 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7053 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7054 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7058 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7061 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7064 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7065 TODO state associated with them,
7067 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7068 in time-sorted view,
7070 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7071 that contain specified keywords,
7073 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7076 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7081 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7082 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7083 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7084 edit these files remotely.
7086 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7087 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7088 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7089 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7090 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7091 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7094 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7095 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7096 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7097 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7098 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7099 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7100 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7101 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7104 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7105 @section Agenda files
7106 @cindex agenda files
7107 @cindex files for agenda
7109 @vindex org-agenda-files
7110 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7111 files}, the files listed in the variable
7112 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7113 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7114 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7115 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7118 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7119 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7120 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7121 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7122 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7123 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7125 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7127 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7128 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7129 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7130 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7131 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7132 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7134 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7135 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7137 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7138 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7139 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7140 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7145 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7146 to visit any of them.
7148 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7149 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7150 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7151 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7152 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7153 extended period, use the following commands:
7156 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7157 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7158 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7159 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7160 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7161 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7162 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7163 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7164 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7168 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7171 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7172 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7173 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7174 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7176 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7177 Lift the restriction.
7180 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7181 @section The agenda dispatcher
7182 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7183 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7184 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7185 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7186 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7187 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7188 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7189 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7192 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7194 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7196 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7197 tags and properties}).
7199 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7201 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7202 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7204 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7205 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7206 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7207 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7208 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7211 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7213 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7214 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7215 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7216 selecting the command.
7218 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7219 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7220 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7221 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7222 character selecting the command.
7225 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7226 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7227 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7228 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7229 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7231 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7232 @section The built-in agenda views
7234 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7237 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7238 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7239 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7240 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7241 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7242 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7245 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7246 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7248 @cindex weekly agenda
7249 @cindex daily agenda
7251 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7252 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7255 @cindex org-agenda, command
7256 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7257 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7258 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7259 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7260 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7261 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7262 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7265 @vindex org-agenda-span
7266 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7267 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7268 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7269 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7270 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7273 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7274 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7275 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7278 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7279 @cindex calendar integration
7280 @cindex diary integration
7282 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7283 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7284 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7285 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7286 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7287 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7290 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7291 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7294 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7297 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7298 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7299 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7300 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7301 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7302 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7303 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7304 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7305 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7306 between calendar and agenda.
7308 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7309 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7310 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7311 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7312 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7313 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7314 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7315 will be made in the agenda:
7318 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7320 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7322 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7323 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7326 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7327 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7328 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7330 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7331 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7332 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7333 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7334 following to one of your agenda files:
7341 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7344 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7345 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7346 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7347 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7348 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7349 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7350 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7356 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7359 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7360 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7361 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7362 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7363 in an Org or Diary file.
7365 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7366 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7367 @cindex appointment reminders
7371 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7372 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7373 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7374 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7375 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7377 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7378 @subsection The global TODO list
7379 @cindex global TODO list
7380 @cindex TODO list, global
7382 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7383 collected into a single place.
7386 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7387 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7388 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7389 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7390 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7391 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7392 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7393 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7394 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7395 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7396 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7397 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7398 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7399 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7401 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7402 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7403 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7404 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7405 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7406 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7409 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7410 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7411 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7413 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7414 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7415 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7419 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7420 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7421 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7422 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7423 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7424 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7425 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7426 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7427 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7428 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7431 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7432 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7433 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7434 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7435 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7438 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7439 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7440 @cindex matching, of tags
7441 @cindex matching, of properties
7445 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7446 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7447 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7448 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7452 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7453 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7454 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7455 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7456 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7457 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7458 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7459 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7460 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7461 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7462 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7463 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7464 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7465 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7469 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7472 @subsubheading Match syntax
7474 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7475 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7476 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7477 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7478 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7479 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7480 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7481 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7482 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7486 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7489 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7490 @item work|laptop+night
7491 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7495 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7496 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7497 braces. For example,
7498 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7499 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7501 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7502 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7503 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7504 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7505 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7506 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7507 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7508 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7509 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7510 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7511 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7512 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7513 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7515 Here are more examples:
7517 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7518 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7519 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7520 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7521 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7524 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7525 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7528 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7529 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7533 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7536 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7537 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7538 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7540 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7541 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7543 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7544 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7545 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7546 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7547 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7548 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.@: without a time
7549 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7550 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7551 respectively, can be used.
7553 If the comparison value is enclosed
7554 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7555 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7559 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7560 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7561 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7562 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7563 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7564 on or after October 11, 2008.
7566 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7567 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7568 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7571 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7572 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7573 inheritance}, for details.
7575 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7576 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7577 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7578 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7579 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7580 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7581 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7582 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7583 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7584 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7585 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7586 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7590 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7591 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7592 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7594 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7595 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7599 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7600 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7601 @cindex timeline, single file
7602 @cindex time-sorted view
7604 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7605 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7606 to give an overview over events in a project.
7609 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7610 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7611 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7612 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7616 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7617 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7619 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7620 @subsection Search view
7623 @cindex searching, for text
7625 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7626 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7629 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7630 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7631 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7633 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7634 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7635 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7636 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7637 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7638 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7639 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7640 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7641 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7642 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7643 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7645 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7646 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7647 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7649 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7650 @subsection Stuck projects
7651 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7653 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7654 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7655 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7656 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7657 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7658 projects and define next actions for them.
7661 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7662 List projects that are stuck.
7665 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7666 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7667 project is and how to find it.
7670 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7671 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7672 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7673 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7675 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7676 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7677 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7678 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7679 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7680 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7681 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7682 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7683 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7684 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7685 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7686 correct customization for this is
7689 (setq org-stuck-projects
7690 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7694 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7695 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7697 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7698 @section Presentation and sorting
7699 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7701 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7702 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7703 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7704 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7705 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7706 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7707 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7708 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7709 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7710 associated with the item.
7713 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7714 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7715 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7718 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7719 @subsection Categories
7723 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7724 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7725 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7726 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7727 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7728 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7729 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7730 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7731 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7739 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7740 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7741 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7742 special category you want to apply as the value.
7745 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7746 longer than 10 characters.
7749 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7750 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7752 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7753 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7754 @cindex time-of-day specification
7756 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7757 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7758 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7759 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7761 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7763 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7764 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7765 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7766 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7768 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7769 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7770 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7773 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7774 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7775 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7776 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7780 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7781 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7784 8:00...... ------------------
7785 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7786 10:00...... ------------------
7787 12:00...... ------------------
7788 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7789 14:00...... ------------------
7790 16:00...... ------------------
7791 18:00...... ------------------
7792 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7793 20:00...... ------------------
7794 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7797 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7798 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7799 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7800 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7801 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7803 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7804 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7805 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7806 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7807 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7808 done depends on the type of view.
7811 @vindex org-agenda-files
7812 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7813 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7814 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7815 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7816 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7817 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7818 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7819 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7820 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7822 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7823 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7824 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7825 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7828 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7829 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7832 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7833 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7834 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7835 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7837 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7838 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7839 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7841 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7842 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7843 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7844 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7845 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7846 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7848 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7849 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7852 @tsubheading{Motion}
7853 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7854 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7855 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7856 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7857 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7858 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7859 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7860 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7861 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7862 outline, not only the heading.
7864 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7865 Display original location and recenter that window.
7867 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7868 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7870 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7871 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7873 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7874 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7875 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7876 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7877 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7878 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7879 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7881 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7882 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7883 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7884 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7885 previously used indirect buffer.
7887 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7888 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7889 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7890 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7892 @tsubheading{Change display}
7893 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7896 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
7900 Delete other windows.
7902 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
7903 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
7904 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
7905 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
7906 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
7907 @vindex org-agenda-span
7908 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
7909 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
7910 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
7911 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
7912 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
7913 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
7914 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
7915 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
7916 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
7917 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
7918 @code{org-agenda-span}.
7920 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
7921 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7922 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7923 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7925 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
7926 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7928 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
7931 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
7932 Prompt for a date and go there.
7934 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7935 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
7937 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
7938 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7940 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
7942 @vindex org-log-done
7943 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7944 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7945 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7946 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7947 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7948 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7949 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7950 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7951 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7953 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
7954 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7955 agenda and timeline views.
7957 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
7958 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
7959 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7960 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7961 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7962 press @kbd{v a} again.
7964 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
7965 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7966 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
7967 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7968 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7969 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7970 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7971 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
7972 when toggling this mode (i.e.@: @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
7973 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
7974 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
7975 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
7978 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
7979 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
7980 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
7981 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
7982 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
7983 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
7986 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
7987 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7988 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7989 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7990 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7991 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7992 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7993 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7995 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
7996 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7997 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7998 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7999 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8001 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8002 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8003 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8004 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8005 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8007 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8010 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8011 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8014 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8015 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8016 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8017 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8018 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8019 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8020 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8021 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8023 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8024 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8025 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8027 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8028 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8029 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8030 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8031 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8032 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8034 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8035 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8037 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8038 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8039 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8042 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8043 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8044 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8045 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8046 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8047 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8048 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8049 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8050 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8051 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8052 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8054 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8055 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8056 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8057 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8058 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8059 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8060 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8061 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8062 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8063 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8065 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8066 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8067 efforts globally, for example
8069 (setq org-global-properties
8070 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8072 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8073 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8074 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8075 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8076 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
8077 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8078 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8079 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8080 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8081 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8083 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8084 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8085 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8086 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8087 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8088 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8089 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8090 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8091 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8095 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8097 ((string= tag "Net")
8098 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8099 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8100 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8101 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8102 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8105 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8109 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8110 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8111 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8112 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8113 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8122 @item @r{in} search view
8123 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8124 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8125 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8126 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8127 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8131 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8132 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8137 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8138 @cindex remote editing, undo
8139 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8140 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8141 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8143 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8144 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8147 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8148 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8149 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8151 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8152 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8153 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8154 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8155 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8156 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8158 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8159 Refile the entry at point.
8161 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8162 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8163 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8164 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8165 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8167 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8168 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8170 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8171 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8174 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8175 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8176 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8179 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8180 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8181 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8182 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8183 tags of a headline occasionally.
8185 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8186 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8187 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8191 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8192 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8193 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8195 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8196 Display weighted priority of current item.
8198 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8199 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8200 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8203 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8204 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8206 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8207 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8208 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8209 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8210 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8212 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8213 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8215 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8216 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8218 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8219 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8221 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
8222 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
8223 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
8226 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
8227 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
8228 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
8229 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
8230 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
8233 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
8236 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8237 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8238 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8240 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8241 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8242 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8243 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8244 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8245 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8246 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8248 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8249 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8252 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8253 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8254 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8256 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8257 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8260 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8261 Stop the previously started clock.
8263 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8264 Cancel the currently running clock.
8266 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8267 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8269 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8270 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8272 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8273 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8276 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8277 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8279 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8280 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8282 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8283 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8285 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8286 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8287 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8288 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8289 these special timestamps.
8291 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8292 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8293 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8294 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8295 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8296 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8297 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8298 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8299 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8300 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8301 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8302 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8303 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8304 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8305 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8306 f @r{Apply a function to marked entries.}
8307 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8309 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8310 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8311 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8312 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8313 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8314 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8315 @r{ (save-excursion}
8316 @r{ (save-restriction}
8318 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8319 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8320 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8324 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8325 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8327 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8328 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8330 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8331 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8334 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8335 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8336 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8337 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8338 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8339 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8340 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8341 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8342 you can add the entry.
8344 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8345 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8346 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8347 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8348 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8349 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8350 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8351 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8352 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8353 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8355 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8356 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8358 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8359 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8360 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8362 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8363 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8366 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8367 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8369 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8370 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8371 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8373 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8374 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8375 @cindex exporting agenda views
8376 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8377 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8378 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8379 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8380 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8381 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8382 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8383 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8384 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8386 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8387 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8388 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8390 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8391 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8392 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8393 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8394 visit Org files will not be removed.
8398 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8399 @section Custom agenda views
8400 @cindex custom agenda views
8401 @cindex agenda views, custom
8403 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8404 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8405 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8406 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8409 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8410 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8411 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8414 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8415 @subsection Storing searches
8417 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8418 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8419 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8422 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8423 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8424 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8425 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8426 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8431 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8432 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8433 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8434 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8435 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8436 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8437 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8438 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8439 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8440 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8441 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8446 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8447 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8448 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8449 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8450 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8451 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8452 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8453 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8454 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8459 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8462 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8463 results as a sparse tree
8465 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8468 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8469 headlines that are also TODO items
8471 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8472 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8474 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8475 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8477 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8478 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8479 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8482 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8483 @subsection Block agenda
8484 @cindex block agenda
8485 @cindex agenda, with block views
8487 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8488 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8489 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8490 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8491 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8492 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8493 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8497 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8498 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8502 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8510 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8511 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8512 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8513 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8514 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8516 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8517 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8518 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8520 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8521 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8522 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8523 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8524 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8525 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8526 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8530 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8531 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8532 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8533 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8534 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8535 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8536 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8538 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8539 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8544 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8545 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8546 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8547 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8548 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8549 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8550 to only a single file.
8552 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8553 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8554 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8555 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8556 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8557 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8558 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8559 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8560 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8561 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8562 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8566 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8567 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8571 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8572 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8573 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8580 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8581 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8582 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8583 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8584 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8588 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8589 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8590 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8592 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8593 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8594 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8595 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8596 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8597 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8598 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8601 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8602 @cindex exporting agenda views
8603 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8604 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8605 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8606 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8607 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8608 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8609 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8610 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8612 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8613 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8614 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8615 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8617 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8618 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8619 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8620 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8621 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8625 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8626 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8627 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8628 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8629 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8630 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8631 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8632 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8633 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8638 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8639 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8640 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8641 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8646 ("~/views/home.html"))
8647 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8652 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8656 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8657 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8658 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8659 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8660 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8661 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8662 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8663 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8665 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8666 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8667 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8671 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8672 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8676 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8677 set options for the export commands. For example:
8680 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8682 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8683 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8684 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8685 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8686 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8691 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8692 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8693 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8694 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8695 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8696 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8697 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8698 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8699 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8702 From the command line you may also use
8704 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8707 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8708 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8710 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8711 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8712 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8713 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8714 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8718 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8719 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8722 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8723 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8727 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8728 @section Using column view in the agenda
8729 @cindex column view, in agenda
8730 @cindex agenda, column view
8732 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8733 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8734 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8735 collected by certain criteria.
8738 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8739 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8742 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8743 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8744 This causes the following issues:
8748 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8749 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8750 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8751 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8752 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8753 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8754 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8755 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8756 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8757 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8759 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8760 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8761 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8762 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8763 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8764 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8765 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8766 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8767 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8768 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8769 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8770 some values will count double.
8772 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8773 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8774 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8775 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8776 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8777 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8778 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8783 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8784 @chapter Markup for rich export
8786 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8787 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8788 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8789 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8790 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
8793 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8794 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8795 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8796 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8797 * Index entries:: Making an index
8798 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8799 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8802 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8803 @section Structural markup elements
8806 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8807 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8808 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8809 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8811 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8812 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8813 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8814 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8815 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8818 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8819 @subheading Document title
8820 @cindex document title, markup rules
8823 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8827 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8831 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8832 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8833 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8834 title will be the file name without extension.
8836 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8837 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8838 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8839 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8841 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8842 @subheading Headings and sections
8843 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8845 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8846 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8847 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8848 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8849 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8850 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8851 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8852 per-file basis with a line
8859 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8860 @subheading Table of contents
8861 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8863 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8864 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8865 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8866 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8867 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8868 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8869 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8870 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8873 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8874 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8877 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8878 @subheading Text before the first headline
8879 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8882 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8883 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8884 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8885 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8887 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8888 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8889 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8890 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8891 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8892 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8895 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8896 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8900 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8901 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8902 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
8905 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8907 @cindex lists, markup rules
8909 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8910 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8913 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8914 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8915 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8917 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8918 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8920 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8921 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8923 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8926 Great clouds overhead
8927 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8934 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8935 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8936 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
8938 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8941 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8942 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8946 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8947 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8950 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8956 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8957 @subheading Footnote markup
8958 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8959 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8961 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
8962 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8963 multiple footnotes side by side.
8965 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8966 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8968 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8969 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8970 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8971 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8972 @cindex code text, markup rules
8973 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8974 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8975 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8976 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
8977 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
8979 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8980 @subheading Horizontal rules
8981 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8982 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
8983 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
8985 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8986 @subheading Comment lines
8987 @cindex comment lines
8988 @cindex exporting, not
8989 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8991 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8992 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8993 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8994 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8995 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9000 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9004 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9005 @section Images and Tables
9007 @cindex tables, markup rules
9010 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9011 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9012 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9013 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9014 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9015 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9018 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9019 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
9024 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9026 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9029 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9030 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9031 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9032 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9033 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9034 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9035 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9038 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9039 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9043 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9044 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9047 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9049 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9050 @section Literal examples
9051 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9052 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9054 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9055 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9056 for source code and similar examples.
9057 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9061 Some example from a text file.
9065 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9066 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9067 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9068 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9069 whitespace before the colon:
9073 : Some example from a text file.
9076 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9077 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9078 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9079 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9080 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9081 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9082 achieved using either the listings or the
9083 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
9084 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
9085 package is included by the @LaTeX{} header (e.g.@: by configuring
9086 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
9087 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
9088 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
9089 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
9090 package is included by the @LaTeX{} header, and ensuring that the
9091 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
9092 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
9093 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
9094 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
9095 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
9096 example@footnote{Code in @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either
9097 interactively or on export. See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more
9098 information on evaluating code blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for
9099 shortcuts to easily insert code blocks.
9103 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9104 (defun org-xor (a b)
9110 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9111 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9112 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9113 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9114 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9115 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e.@: the reference name
9116 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9117 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9120 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9121 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9122 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9123 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9124 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9125 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9129 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9130 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9131 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9133 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9137 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9138 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9139 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9140 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9142 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9143 areas in HTML export}).
9145 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9146 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9147 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9152 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9153 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9154 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
9155 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
9156 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
9157 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
9158 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
9159 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
9160 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
9161 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
9162 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
9166 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9167 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9168 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9169 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9170 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9174 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9175 @section Include files
9176 @cindex include files, markup rules
9178 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9179 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9183 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9186 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g.@: @samp{quote},
9187 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9188 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9189 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9190 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9191 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9192 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9193 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9194 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9198 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9201 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9202 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9203 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9207 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9208 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9209 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9215 Visit the include file at point.
9218 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9219 @section Index entries
9220 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9222 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9223 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9224 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9225 an index} for more information.
9230 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9236 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9237 @section Macro replacement
9238 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9241 You can define text snippets with
9244 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9247 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9248 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9249 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9250 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9251 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9252 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9253 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9254 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9255 @code{format-time-string}.
9257 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9258 construct complex HTML code.
9261 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9262 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9263 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9264 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9266 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9267 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9268 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9269 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9270 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9271 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9272 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9273 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9274 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9277 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9278 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9279 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9280 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9281 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9284 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9285 @subsection Special symbols
9286 @cindex math symbols
9287 @cindex special symbols
9288 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9289 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9290 @cindex HTML entities
9291 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9293 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9294 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9295 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9296 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9297 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9298 delimiters, for example:
9301 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9304 @vindex org-entities
9305 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9306 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9307 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9308 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9309 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9310 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9312 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9313 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9314 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9315 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9316 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9318 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9319 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9320 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9321 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9326 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9327 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9328 for display purposes only.
9331 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9332 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9336 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9337 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9338 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9339 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9340 with curly braces. For example
9343 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9344 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9347 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9348 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9349 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9350 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9351 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9352 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9353 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9359 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9360 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9365 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9366 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9369 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9370 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9371 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9373 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9374 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9375 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9376 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9377 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9378 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9379 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9380 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9381 @file{MathJax} on your own
9382 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9383 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9384 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9385 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
9386 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The @LaTeX{} header that will
9387 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9388 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9391 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9392 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9395 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9396 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9397 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9398 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9399 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9401 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9402 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9403 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9404 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9405 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9406 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9407 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9410 @noindent For example:
9413 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9414 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9415 \end@{equation@} % etc
9417 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9418 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9422 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9423 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9424 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9425 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9427 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9428 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9429 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9430 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9431 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9435 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9436 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9437 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9438 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9441 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9442 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9443 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9445 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9446 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9451 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9452 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9453 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9454 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9455 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9456 process the entire buffer.
9459 Remove the overlay preview images.
9462 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9463 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9464 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9465 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9468 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9469 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9472 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9473 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9474 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9475 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9476 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9477 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9478 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9479 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9480 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9484 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9487 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9488 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9492 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9495 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9496 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9497 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9498 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9499 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9500 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9501 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9502 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9503 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9504 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9505 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9509 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9510 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9511 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9512 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9513 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9514 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9517 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9518 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9519 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9522 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9523 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9524 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9525 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9529 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9533 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9534 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9535 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9536 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9537 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9538 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9539 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9540 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9541 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9542 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9543 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9544 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9545 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9546 these different formats.
9548 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9549 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9552 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9553 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9554 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9555 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9556 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9557 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9558 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9559 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9560 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9561 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9562 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9563 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9566 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9567 @section Selective export
9568 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9570 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9571 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9572 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9573 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9574 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9575 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9576 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9580 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9581 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9582 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9583 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9586 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9590 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9591 be removed from the export buffer.
9594 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9595 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9596 variable for more information.
9598 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9599 @section Export options
9600 @cindex options, for export
9602 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9603 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9604 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9605 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9606 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9607 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9608 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9609 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9610 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9611 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9614 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9615 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9622 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9630 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9631 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9633 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9634 @vindex user-full-name
9635 @vindex user-mail-address
9636 @vindex org-export-default-language
9637 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9639 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9640 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9641 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9642 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9643 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9644 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9645 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g.@: @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9646 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9647 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9648 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9649 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.@:: @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9650 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9651 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9652 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9653 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9654 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9655 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9656 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9660 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9661 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9662 settings. Here you can:
9663 @cindex headline levels
9664 @cindex section-numbers
9665 @cindex table of contents
9666 @cindex line-break preservation
9667 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9668 @cindex fixed-width sections
9670 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9672 @cindex special strings
9673 @cindex emphasized text
9674 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9675 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9676 @cindex author info, in export
9677 @cindex time info, in export
9678 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9679 @vindex org-export-author-info
9680 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9681 @vindex org-export-email-info
9682 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9684 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9685 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9686 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9687 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9688 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9689 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9690 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9691 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9692 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9693 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9694 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9695 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9696 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9697 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9698 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9699 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9700 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9701 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9702 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9703 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9704 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9705 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9706 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9707 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9708 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9709 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9710 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9713 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9714 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9715 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9717 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9718 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9719 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9720 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9722 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9723 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9724 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9725 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9726 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9728 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9729 @section The export dispatcher
9730 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9732 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9733 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9734 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9735 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9736 the subtrees are exported.
9739 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9740 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9741 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9742 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9743 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9744 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9745 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9746 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9747 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9748 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9749 (i.e.@: not hidden by outline visibility).
9750 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9751 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9752 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9753 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e.@: request background processing if
9754 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9757 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9758 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9759 @cindex ASCII export
9760 @cindex Latin-1 export
9761 @cindex UTF-8 export
9763 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9764 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9765 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9767 @cindex region, active
9768 @cindex active region
9769 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9771 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9772 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9773 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9774 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9775 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9776 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9777 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9778 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9779 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9780 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9782 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9783 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9784 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9785 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9786 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9787 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9788 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9789 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9790 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9791 Export only the visible part of the document.
9794 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9795 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9796 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9797 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9798 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9805 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9806 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9807 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9808 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9809 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9810 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9811 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9813 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9814 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9815 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9816 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9818 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9819 @section HTML export
9822 Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9823 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9824 language, but with additional support for tables.
9827 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9828 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
9829 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
9830 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9831 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9832 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9833 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9834 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9835 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9836 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9839 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
9840 @subsection HTML export commands
9842 @cindex region, active
9843 @cindex active region
9844 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9846 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9847 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9848 Export as HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9849 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9850 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9851 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9852 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9853 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9854 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9855 property, that name will be used for the export.
9856 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9857 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9858 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9859 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9860 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9861 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9862 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9863 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9864 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9865 Export only the visible part of the document.
9866 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9867 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org mode
9868 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9870 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9871 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
9875 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9876 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9877 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9878 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9879 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9886 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9889 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9890 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
9891 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
9892 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
9893 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
9894 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
9895 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
9896 @vindex org-export-author-info
9897 @vindex org-export-email-info
9898 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9899 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9901 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
9903 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
9904 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant formatting
9905 string in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
9907 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
9908 formatting string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
9909 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
9910 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
9911 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
9912 insert any preamble.
9914 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
9915 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
9916 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
9917 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
9918 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
9919 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
9920 postamble from the relevant formatting string found in
9921 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
9922 insert any postamble.
9924 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
9925 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9927 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9928 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9929 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9930 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9931 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9932 the exported file use either
9935 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9937 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9941 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9945 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9950 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9951 @subsection Links in HTML export
9953 @cindex links, in HTML export
9954 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9955 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9956 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9957 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9958 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9959 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9960 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9961 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9962 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9963 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9964 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9966 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9967 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9968 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9969 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9973 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9974 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9977 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9979 @cindex tables, in HTML
9980 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9982 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9983 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9984 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9985 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9990 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9991 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
9994 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9995 @subsection Images in HTML export
9997 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9998 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9999 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10000 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10001 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10002 default@footnote{But see the variable
10003 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10004 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10005 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10006 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10007 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10008 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10009 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10010 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10013 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10016 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10017 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10018 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10021 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10023 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10024 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10029 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10031 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10032 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10036 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10037 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10038 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10039 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10040 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10041 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10042 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10043 found on the MathJax website, see
10044 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10045 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10046 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10047 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10050 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10053 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10054 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10057 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10058 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10059 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10060 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10061 You can still get this processing with
10064 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10067 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10068 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10070 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10071 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10072 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10073 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10074 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10075 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10076 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10077 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10078 respectively. For example
10081 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10082 (defun org-xor (a b)
10089 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10090 @subsection CSS support
10091 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10092 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10094 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10095 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10096 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10097 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10098 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10099 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10100 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10101 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10102 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10104 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10105 p.date @r{publishing date}
10106 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10107 .title @r{document title}
10108 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10109 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10110 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10111 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10112 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10113 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10114 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10115 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10116 .target @r{target for links}
10117 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10118 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10119 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10120 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10121 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10122 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10123 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10124 pre.example @r{normal example}
10125 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10126 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10127 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10128 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10129 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10132 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10133 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10134 @vindex org-export-html-style
10135 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10136 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10137 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10138 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10139 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10140 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10141 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10142 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10143 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10144 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10145 individually for each file, you can use
10149 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10153 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10154 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10155 referring to an external file.
10157 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10158 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10159 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10162 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10163 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10165 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10166 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10168 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10169 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10170 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10171 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10172 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10173 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10174 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10175 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10176 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10177 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10178 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10179 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10180 copy on your own web server.
10182 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10183 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10184 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10185 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10186 adding a single line to the Org file:
10188 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10190 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10194 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10195 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10199 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10200 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10201 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10202 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10203 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10204 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10205 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10206 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10207 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10208 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10209 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10210 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10211 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10212 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10213 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10214 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10215 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10216 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10217 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10218 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10219 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10220 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10221 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10222 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10223 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10226 @vindex org-infojs-options
10227 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10228 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10229 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10230 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10232 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10233 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10234 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10236 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10238 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10239 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10240 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10241 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10242 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10243 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10244 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10245 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10246 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10247 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10251 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10252 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10253 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10254 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10255 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10256 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10259 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10260 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10262 @cindex region, active
10263 @cindex active region
10264 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10266 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10267 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10268 Export as @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10269 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10270 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10271 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10272 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10273 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10274 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10275 property, that name will be used for the export.
10276 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10277 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10278 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10279 Export only the visible part of the document.
10280 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10281 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was Org mode
10282 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10284 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10285 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10287 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10288 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10289 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10290 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10293 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10294 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10295 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10296 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10297 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10298 convert them to a custom string depending on
10299 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10301 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10302 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10305 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10309 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10311 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10312 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10313 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10314 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10315 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10316 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10317 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10319 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10321 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10322 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10323 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10324 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10325 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
10326 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
10327 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10328 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
10329 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10330 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10331 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10332 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10333 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10334 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10335 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10336 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10337 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10338 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10339 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
10340 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
10341 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
10342 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
10345 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10346 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10348 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10349 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10350 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10351 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10352 the following constructs:
10355 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10357 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10361 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10365 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10370 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10371 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10372 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10374 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10375 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10376 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10377 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10378 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10379 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10380 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10385 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10387 #+CAPTION: A long table
10389 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10394 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10398 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10400 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10402 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10407 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10408 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10409 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10410 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10412 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10413 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10414 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10415 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10416 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10417 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10418 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10419 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10420 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10421 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10422 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10423 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10424 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10425 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10426 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10427 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}. For example the
10428 @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line below is exported as the @code{figure} environment
10431 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10432 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10433 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10434 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10435 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10436 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10440 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10442 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10443 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10444 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10445 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10447 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10451 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10452 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10453 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10455 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10456 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10458 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10459 @subsection Beamer class export
10461 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10462 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10463 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10465 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10466 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10467 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10468 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10469 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10470 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10471 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10472 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10473 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10474 structure of the presentation.
10476 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10477 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10478 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10479 editing special properties used by beamer.
10481 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10486 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10487 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10488 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10489 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10490 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10491 @item BEAMER_envargs
10492 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10493 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10494 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10495 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10496 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10499 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10500 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10501 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10502 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10503 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10504 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10505 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10506 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10508 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10509 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10513 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10514 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10515 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10516 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
10517 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10518 in the presentation as well.
10520 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10521 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10522 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10523 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10524 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10525 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10526 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10528 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10536 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10537 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10538 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10541 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10542 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10543 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10544 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10546 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10549 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10550 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10551 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10552 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10553 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10554 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10555 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10557 * This is the first structural section
10559 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10560 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10563 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10566 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10567 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10571 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10573 for contributing to the discussion
10574 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10575 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10576 *** Request :B_block:
10577 Please test this stuff!
10583 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10585 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10586 @section DocBook export
10587 @cindex DocBook export
10589 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10591 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10592 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10593 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10594 tools and stylesheets.
10596 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10599 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10600 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10601 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10602 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10603 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10604 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10607 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10608 @subsection DocBook export commands
10610 @cindex region, active
10611 @cindex active region
10612 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10614 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10615 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10616 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10617 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10618 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10619 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10620 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10621 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10622 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10623 property, that name will be used for the export.
10624 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10625 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10627 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10628 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10629 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10630 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10631 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10632 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10634 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10635 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10636 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10637 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10638 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10639 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10641 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10642 Export only the visible part of the document.
10645 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10646 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10648 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10649 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10652 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10654 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10658 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10662 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10667 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10668 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10669 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10670 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10675 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10676 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10677 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10682 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10683 @subsection Recursive sections
10684 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10686 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10687 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e.@: @code{section} elements, are
10688 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10689 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10690 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10691 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10693 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10694 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10696 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10697 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10698 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10700 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10703 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10704 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10705 using the @code{table} element.
10707 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10708 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10709 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10710 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10712 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10713 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10714 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10715 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10716 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10717 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10718 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10719 @code{mediaobject} element.
10721 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10722 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10723 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10724 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10725 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10726 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10727 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10728 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10730 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10731 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10732 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10733 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10734 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10739 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10741 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10742 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10743 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10744 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10747 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10748 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10749 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10750 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10751 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10753 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10754 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10755 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10757 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10758 @vindex org-entities
10759 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10760 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10761 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10762 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10763 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10764 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10766 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10767 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10768 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10769 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10772 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10773 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10774 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10775 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10782 @c begin opendocument
10784 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
10785 @section OpenDocument Text export
10786 @cindex K, Jambunathan
10788 @cindex OpenDocument
10789 @cindex export, OpenDocument
10790 @cindex LibreOffice
10792 @cindex org-modules
10794 Orgmode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
10795 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
10796 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
10797 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
10798 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
10799 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
10802 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
10803 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
10804 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
10805 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
10806 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10807 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
10808 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
10809 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
10810 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
10811 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
10812 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
10815 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
10816 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
10818 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
10819 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
10821 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
10822 @subsection ODT export commands
10824 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
10825 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
10827 @cindex region, active
10828 @cindex active region
10829 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10831 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
10832 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10834 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
10836 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10837 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
10838 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
10839 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
10841 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
10842 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
10843 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
10844 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
10845 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
10846 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
10847 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10850 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
10851 Export as OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
10853 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10854 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
10855 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
10856 exporting to other formats}.
10859 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
10860 @subsection Extending ODT export
10862 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
10863 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
10864 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
10865 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
10867 @cindex @file{unoconv}
10868 @cindex LibreOffice
10869 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
10870 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
10871 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
10872 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
10873 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
10874 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
10875 document converter}.
10877 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
10878 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
10880 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10881 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
10882 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
10883 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
10884 preferred output format by customizing the variable
10885 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
10886 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
10887 format that is of immediate interest to you.
10889 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
10890 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
10892 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
10893 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
10894 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
10895 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
10896 the following command.
10898 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
10901 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
10902 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
10903 argument, also open the newly produced file.
10906 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
10907 @subsection Applying custom styles
10908 @cindex styles, custom
10909 @cindex template, custom
10911 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
10912 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
10913 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
10914 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
10915 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
10916 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
10917 users alike, and is described here.
10919 @subsubsection Applying custom styles - the easy way
10923 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
10927 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
10931 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
10932 to locate the target styles - these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix -
10933 and modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
10934 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
10937 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
10938 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
10939 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
10940 newly created file. For additional configuration options
10941 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
10943 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
10944 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
10947 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
10953 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
10958 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
10960 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
10961 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
10962 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
10963 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
10964 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
10965 the factory settings.
10967 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
10968 @subsection Links in ODT export
10969 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10971 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
10972 Internet-style links for all other links.
10974 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
10975 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
10977 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
10978 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
10979 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
10981 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
10982 @subsection Tables in ODT export
10983 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10985 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
10986 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables -
10987 tables that have column or row spans - is not supported. Such tables are
10988 stripped from the exported document.
10990 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
10991 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
10992 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
10993 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
10994 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
10995 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
10998 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
10999 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11001 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11005 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11006 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11007 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11009 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11010 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11011 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11012 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11013 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11014 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11017 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11018 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11019 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11020 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11021 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11023 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11024 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11025 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11027 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11028 @subsection Images in ODT export
11029 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11030 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11032 @subsubheading Embedding images
11033 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11034 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11035 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11045 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11046 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11047 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11048 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11049 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11052 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11055 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11058 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11059 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11061 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11062 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11063 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11064 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11065 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11066 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11067 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11068 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11069 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11070 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11071 converted in to units of centimeters using
11072 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11073 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11074 achieve the best results.
11076 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11079 @item Explicitly size the image
11080 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11083 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11087 @item Scale the image
11088 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11091 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11095 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11096 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11097 height:width ratio, do the following:
11100 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11104 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11105 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11106 height:width ratio, do the following
11109 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11114 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11117 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11118 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11119 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property -
11120 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11122 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11124 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11128 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11129 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11131 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11134 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11135 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11138 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11139 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11141 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11142 document in one of the following ways:
11148 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11154 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11155 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11156 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11157 the exported document.
11159 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11160 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11162 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11163 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11164 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11166 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11167 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11168 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11171 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11172 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11173 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11174 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11177 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11178 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11182 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11183 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11185 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11186 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file and
11187 open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11193 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11196 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11199 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11200 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11201 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11204 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11205 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11207 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11208 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11209 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11210 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11222 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11223 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11225 You can label and caption various category of objects - an inline image, a
11226 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula - using @code{#+LABEL} and
11227 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11228 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11229 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11230 appearance in the Org file.
11232 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11233 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11237 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11238 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11242 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11245 Figure 2: Bell curve
11248 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11249 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11250 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11251 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11252 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11255 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11256 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11259 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11263 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11266 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11267 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11269 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11270 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11271 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11272 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11273 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11274 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11275 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11277 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11278 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11279 by customizing the variable
11280 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11282 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11283 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11284 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11286 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11287 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11289 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11290 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11291 that would be of interest to power users.
11294 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11295 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11296 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11297 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11298 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11301 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11302 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11304 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11307 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11308 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11309 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11310 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11313 @item Register the converter
11315 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11316 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11317 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11318 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11320 @item Configure its capabilities
11322 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11323 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11324 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11325 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11326 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11327 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11328 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11329 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11331 @item Choose the converter
11333 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11334 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11335 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11338 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11339 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11340 @cindex styles, custom
11341 @cindex template, custom
11343 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11344 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11345 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11348 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11349 @subsubheading Factory styles
11351 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11352 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11353 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11356 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11358 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11360 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11361 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11365 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11368 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11372 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11374 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11376 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11377 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11378 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11380 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11381 file serves the following purposes:
11385 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11389 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11390 elements that control how various entities - tables, images, equations etc -
11395 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11396 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11397 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11398 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11399 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11403 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11405 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11407 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11408 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11411 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11413 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11415 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11417 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11420 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11422 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11423 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11424 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11426 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11427 like header and footer images.
11431 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11434 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11436 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11438 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11439 in the final output.
11442 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11443 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11445 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11446 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11447 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11450 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11452 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11453 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11456 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11457 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11461 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11462 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11463 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11466 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11467 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11471 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11473 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11474 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11477 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11480 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11481 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11482 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11485 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11486 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11487 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11491 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11493 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11494 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11496 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11501 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11502 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11509 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11510 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11511 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11514 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11515 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11516 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11518 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11520 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11521 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11525 @subsubheading Custom table styles - an illustration
11527 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11528 the table that follows.
11531 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11532 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11533 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11534 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11535 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11536 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11537 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11538 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11542 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11543 | Name | Phone | Age |
11544 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11545 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11548 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11549 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11550 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11551 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11552 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11553 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11554 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11555 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11557 @subsubheading Custom table styles - the nitty-gritty
11558 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11562 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11563 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11565 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11566 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11580 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11581 template using a well-defined convention.
11583 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11584 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11585 the following table.
11587 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11588 @headitem Table cell type
11589 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11590 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11595 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11596 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11598 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11599 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11601 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11602 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11604 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11605 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11607 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11608 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11610 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11611 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11613 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11614 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11616 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11617 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11619 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11620 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11623 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11625 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11626 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11630 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11631 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11632 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11633 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11634 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11635 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11637 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11638 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11639 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11642 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11643 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11646 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11647 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11648 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11649 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11652 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11653 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11654 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11655 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11656 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11657 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11658 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11659 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11663 Associate a table with the table style
11665 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11666 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11669 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11670 | Name | Phone | Age |
11671 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11672 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11676 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11677 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11679 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11680 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11681 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11682 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11683 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11685 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11686 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11687 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11688 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11690 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11691 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11692 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11693 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11694 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11695 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11697 @c end opendocument
11699 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11700 @section TaskJuggler export
11701 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11702 @cindex Project management
11704 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11705 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11706 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11709 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11710 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11711 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11714 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11715 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11716 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11719 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11722 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11723 Export as TaskJuggler file.
11725 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11726 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11731 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11732 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11733 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11734 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11735 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11736 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11737 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11738 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11739 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11740 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11742 @subsection Resources
11744 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11745 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11746 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11747 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11748 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11749 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11750 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11751 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11752 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11753 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11754 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11755 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11756 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11758 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11759 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11762 @subsection Export of properties
11764 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.@: if a
11765 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
11766 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
11767 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
11768 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
11769 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
11770 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
11771 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
11772 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
11774 @subsection Dependencies
11776 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
11777 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
11778 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
11779 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
11780 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
11781 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
11782 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
11783 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
11784 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
11785 examples should illustrate this:
11790 :task_id: preparation
11793 * Training material
11795 :task_id: training_material
11798 ** Markup Guidelines
11802 ** Workflow Guidelines
11809 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
11813 @subsection Reports
11815 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
11816 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g.@: gantt chart, resource
11817 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
11818 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
11819 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
11820 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
11821 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
11822 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
11824 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
11825 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
11827 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
11828 @section Freemind export
11829 @cindex Freemind export
11832 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
11835 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
11836 Export as Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
11837 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
11840 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
11841 @section XOXO export
11842 @cindex XOXO export
11844 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
11845 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
11846 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
11849 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
11850 Export as XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
11851 @file{myfile.html}.
11852 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
11853 Export only the visible part of the document.
11856 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
11857 @section iCalendar export
11858 @cindex iCalendar export
11860 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
11861 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
11862 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
11863 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
11864 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
11865 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
11866 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
11867 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
11868 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
11869 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
11870 included in the export, configure the variable
11871 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
11872 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
11873 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
11874 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
11875 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
11876 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
11877 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
11878 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
11879 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
11882 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
11883 @cindex property, ID
11884 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
11885 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
11886 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
11887 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
11888 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
11889 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
11890 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
11891 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
11892 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
11895 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
11896 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
11897 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
11898 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
11899 @vindex org-agenda-files
11900 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
11901 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
11902 file will be written.
11903 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
11904 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
11905 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
11906 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
11907 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
11910 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
11911 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
11912 @cindex property, SUMMARY
11913 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
11914 @cindex property, LOCATION
11915 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
11916 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
11917 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
11918 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
11919 and the description from the body (limited to
11920 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
11922 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
11923 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
11925 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
11926 @chapter Publishing
11929 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
11930 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
11931 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
11932 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
11935 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
11936 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
11938 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
11941 * Configuration:: Defining projects
11942 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
11943 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
11944 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
11947 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
11948 @section Configuration
11950 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
11951 and many other properties of a project.
11954 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
11955 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
11956 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
11957 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
11958 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
11959 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
11960 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
11961 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
11964 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
11965 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
11966 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
11967 @cindex projects, for publishing
11969 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
11970 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
11971 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
11972 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
11975 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
11976 @r{i.e.@: a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
11978 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
11982 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
11983 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
11984 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
11985 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
11986 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
11987 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
11988 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
11991 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
11992 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
11993 @cindex directories, for publishing
11995 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
11996 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
11997 and where to put published files.
11999 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12000 @item @code{:base-directory}
12001 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12002 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12003 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12004 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12005 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12006 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12007 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12008 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12009 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12010 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12011 variable @code{project-plist}.
12012 @item @code{:completion-function}
12013 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12014 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12015 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12016 @code{project-plist}.
12020 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12021 @subsection Selecting files
12022 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12024 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12025 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12027 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12028 @item @code{:base-extension}
12029 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12030 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12031 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12033 @item @code{:exclude}
12034 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12035 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12038 @item @code{:include}
12039 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12040 and @code{:exclude}.
12042 @item @code{:recursive}
12043 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12046 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12047 @subsection Publishing action
12048 @cindex action, for publishing
12050 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12051 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12052 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12053 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12054 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12055 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12056 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12057 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12058 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12059 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12060 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12061 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12062 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12063 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12064 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12065 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12066 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12067 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12068 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12070 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12071 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12072 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12073 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12074 @item @code{:plain-source}
12075 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12076 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12077 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12080 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12081 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12082 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12083 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12084 and place the result into the destination folder.
12086 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12087 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12088 @cindex options, for publishing
12090 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12091 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12092 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12093 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12094 respective variable for details.
12096 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12097 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12098 @vindex org-export-default-language
12099 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12100 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12101 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12102 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12103 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12104 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12105 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12106 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12107 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12108 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12109 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12110 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12111 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12112 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12113 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12114 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12115 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12116 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12117 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12118 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12119 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12120 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12121 @vindex org-export-author-info
12122 @vindex org-export-email-info
12123 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12124 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12125 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12126 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12127 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12128 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12129 @vindex org-export-html-style
12130 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12131 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12132 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12133 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12134 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12135 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12136 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12137 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12138 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12139 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12140 @vindex user-full-name
12141 @vindex user-mail-address
12142 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12143 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12145 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12146 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12147 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12148 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12149 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12150 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12151 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12152 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12153 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12154 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12155 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12156 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12157 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12158 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12159 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12160 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12161 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12162 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12163 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12164 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12165 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12166 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12167 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12168 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12169 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12170 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12171 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12172 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12173 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12174 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12175 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12176 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12177 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12178 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12179 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12180 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12181 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12182 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12183 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12184 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12185 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12186 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12187 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12188 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12189 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12190 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12191 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12192 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12193 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12194 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12197 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12198 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12199 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12200 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12205 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12206 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12207 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12208 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12209 options}), however, override everything.
12211 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12212 @subsection Links between published files
12213 @cindex links, publishing
12215 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12216 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12217 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12218 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12219 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12220 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12221 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12222 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12225 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12226 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12227 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12228 an example of this usage.
12230 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12231 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12232 location. In this case, use the property
12234 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12235 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12236 @tab Function to validate links
12240 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12241 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12242 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12243 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12244 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12245 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12246 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12248 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12249 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12250 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12252 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12253 a map of files for a given project.
12255 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12256 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12257 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12258 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12260 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12261 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12262 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12264 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12265 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12267 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12268 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12269 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12270 of links to all files in the project.
12272 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12273 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12274 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12275 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12277 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12278 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12279 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12280 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12281 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12282 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12283 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12285 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12286 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12288 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12289 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12290 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12291 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12292 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12293 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12294 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12296 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12297 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12298 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12299 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12301 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12302 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12303 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12304 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12308 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12309 @subsection Generating an index
12310 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12312 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12314 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12315 @item @code{:makeindex}
12316 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12317 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12320 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12321 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
12322 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12323 a title, style information, etc.
12325 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12326 @section Uploading files
12330 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12331 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12332 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12333 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12334 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12337 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12338 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12339 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12340 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12341 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12343 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12344 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12345 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12346 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12347 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12348 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12351 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12352 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12353 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12354 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12355 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
12356 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12358 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12359 @section Sample configuration
12361 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12362 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12363 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12366 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12367 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12370 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12371 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12373 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12374 directory on the local machine.
12377 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12379 :base-directory "~/org/"
12380 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12381 :section-numbers nil
12382 :table-of-contents nil
12383 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12384 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12385 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12388 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12389 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12391 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12392 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12393 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12396 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12397 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12398 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12399 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12402 file:../images/myimage.png
12405 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12406 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12407 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12410 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12412 :base-directory "~/org/"
12413 :base-extension "org"
12414 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12415 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12416 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12418 :section-numbers nil
12419 :table-of-contents nil
12420 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12421 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12425 :base-directory "~/images/"
12426 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12427 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12428 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12431 :base-directory "~/other/"
12432 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12433 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12434 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12435 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12438 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12439 @section Triggering publication
12441 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12444 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12445 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12446 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12447 Publish the project containing the current file.
12448 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12449 Publish only the current file.
12450 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12451 Publish every project.
12454 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12455 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12456 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12457 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12458 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12459 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12460 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12462 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12463 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12465 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12466 @chapter Working with source code
12467 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12468 @cindex Davison, Dan
12469 @cindex source code, working with
12471 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12475 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12476 (defun org-xor (a b)
12482 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12483 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12484 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12485 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12486 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12487 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12489 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12492 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12493 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12494 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12495 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12496 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12497 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12498 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12499 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12500 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12501 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12502 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12503 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12506 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12507 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12509 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12510 @section Structure of code blocks
12511 @cindex code block, structure
12512 @cindex source code, block structure
12514 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12516 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12517 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12518 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12522 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12527 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12528 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12529 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12530 @cindex source code, inline
12532 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12535 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12541 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12545 @item <#+NAME: name>
12546 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12547 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12548 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12549 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12550 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12551 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12555 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12556 @cindex source code, language
12558 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12559 @ref{Literal examples})
12560 @cindex source code, switches
12561 @item <header arguments>
12562 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12563 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12564 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12565 basis using properties.
12566 @item source code, header arguments
12568 Source code in the specified language.
12571 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12572 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12574 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12575 @section Editing source code
12576 @cindex code block, editing
12577 @cindex source code, editing
12580 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12581 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12582 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12583 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12585 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12586 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12587 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12588 further configuration options.
12591 @item org-src-lang-modes
12592 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12593 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12594 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12595 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12596 @item org-src-window-setup
12597 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12598 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12599 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12600 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12601 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12602 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12603 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12606 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12607 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12609 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12610 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12612 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12613 @section Exporting code blocks
12614 @cindex code block, exporting
12615 @cindex source code, exporting
12617 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12618 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12619 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12620 However, for some languages (e.g.@: @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12621 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12622 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12624 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12627 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12629 @item :exports code
12630 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12631 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12632 @item :exports results
12633 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12634 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12635 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12636 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12637 block will not be exported.
12638 @item :exports both
12639 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12640 @item :exports none
12641 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12644 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12645 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12646 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12647 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12648 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12649 markup language for a wiki.
12651 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12652 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12653 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12654 @section Extracting source code
12656 @cindex source code, extracting
12657 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12659 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12660 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12661 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12662 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12663 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12665 @subsubheading Header arguments
12668 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12670 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12671 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12672 for the block language.
12673 @item :tangle filename
12674 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12678 @subsubheading Functions
12680 @item org-babel-tangle
12681 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12682 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12683 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12686 @subsubheading Hooks
12688 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12689 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12690 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12691 of tangled code files.
12694 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12695 @section Evaluating code blocks
12696 @cindex code block, evaluating
12697 @cindex source code, evaluating
12700 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12701 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12702 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12703 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12704 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12705 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12706 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12707 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12708 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12709 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12711 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12712 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12713 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12714 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12715 used to define a code block).
12718 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12719 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12720 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12721 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12722 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12723 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12726 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
12727 Org mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12728 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12729 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12730 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12732 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12735 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12736 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12739 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12742 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12743 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12748 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12750 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12751 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12752 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12753 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12754 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12755 @item <inside header arguments>
12756 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12757 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12758 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12759 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12760 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12761 @item <end header arguments>
12762 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12763 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12764 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12765 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
12766 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
12768 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
12769 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
12772 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
12773 @section Library of Babel
12774 @cindex babel, library of
12775 @cindex source code, library
12776 @cindex code block, library
12778 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
12779 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
12780 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
12781 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
12784 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
12785 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
12787 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
12788 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
12789 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
12793 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
12794 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
12797 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
12799 @cindex babel, languages
12800 @cindex source code, languages
12801 @cindex code block, languages
12803 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
12805 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
12806 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
12807 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
12808 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
12809 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
12810 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
12811 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
12812 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
12813 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
12814 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
12815 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
12816 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
12817 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
12818 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
12819 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
12820 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
12821 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
12822 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
12823 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
12824 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
12827 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
12828 available, it can be found at
12829 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
12831 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
12832 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
12833 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
12834 to your emacs configuration.
12837 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
12838 @code{R} code blocks.
12842 (org-babel-do-load-languages
12843 'org-babel-load-languages
12844 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
12848 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
12849 elisp file with @code{require}.
12852 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
12856 (require 'ob-clojure)
12859 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
12860 @section Header arguments
12861 @cindex code block, header arguments
12862 @cindex source code, block header arguments
12864 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
12865 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
12866 describes each header argument in detail.
12869 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
12870 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
12873 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
12874 @subsection Using header arguments
12876 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
12877 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
12879 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
12880 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
12881 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
12882 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
12883 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
12884 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
12888 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
12889 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
12890 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
12891 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
12892 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
12896 :results => "replace"
12903 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
12905 @c ((:session . "none")
12906 @c (:results . "replace")
12907 @c (:exports . "code")
12909 @c (:noweb . "no"))
12913 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
12916 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
12917 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
12918 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
12922 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
12923 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
12924 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
12927 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
12928 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
12929 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
12930 language-specific documentation available online at
12931 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
12933 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
12934 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
12935 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
12936 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
12937 @ref{Property syntax}).
12939 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
12940 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
12941 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
12942 inserted into the buffer.
12945 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
12946 #+PROPERTY: results silent
12949 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
12950 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
12952 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
12953 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
12954 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
12957 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
12960 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12961 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
12962 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
12963 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
12964 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
12965 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
12975 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
12976 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
12977 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
12978 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
12979 in Org mode documents.
12981 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
12982 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
12984 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
12985 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
12986 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
12987 Properties set in this way override both the values of
12988 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
12989 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
12990 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
12991 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
12992 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
12993 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
12997 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
12999 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13002 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13005 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13008 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13009 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13010 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13014 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13016 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13017 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13018 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13025 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13027 #+NAME: named-block
13028 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13029 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13030 (message "data:%S" data)
13033 #+results: named-block
13037 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13038 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13039 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13041 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13042 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13043 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13046 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13047 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13049 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13052 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13053 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13055 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13058 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13059 @subsection Specific header arguments
13060 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13061 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13064 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13065 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13066 be collected and handled
13067 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13068 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13069 directory for code block execution
13070 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13071 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13072 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13073 files during tangling
13074 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13076 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13078 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13079 expansion during tangling
13080 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13081 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13082 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13083 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13084 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13085 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13086 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13087 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13088 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13089 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13090 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13093 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13096 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13097 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13098 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13099 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13100 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13101 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13102 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13104 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13105 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13106 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13107 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13108 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13111 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13112 Indexable variable values}).
13114 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13115 @code{:var} header argument.
13121 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13122 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13123 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13124 results of evaluating another code block.
13126 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13131 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13133 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13139 #+NAME: table-length
13140 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13144 #+results: table-length
13149 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13150 carried through to the source code block)
13153 #+NAME: example-list
13159 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13167 @item code block without arguments
13168 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13169 optionally followed by parentheses
13172 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13180 @item code block with arguments
13181 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13182 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13183 code block name using standard function call syntax
13187 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13195 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13203 @item literal example
13204 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13207 #+NAME: literal-example
13213 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13214 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13215 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13218 #+results: read-literal-example
13219 : A literal example
13220 : on two lines for you.
13226 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13227 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13228 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13229 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13230 following the source name.
13233 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13234 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13239 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13240 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13241 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13242 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13243 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13244 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13245 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13246 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13247 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13250 #+NAME: example-table
13256 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13264 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13265 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13266 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13270 #+NAME: example-table
13277 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13287 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13288 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13289 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13290 column is referenced.
13293 #+NAME: example-table
13299 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13307 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13308 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13309 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13313 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13314 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13315 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13316 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13319 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13327 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13329 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13330 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13331 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13332 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13333 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13334 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13335 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13336 evaluation of the code block body.
13339 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13344 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13345 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13351 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13360 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13361 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13363 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13364 per class may be supplied per code block.
13368 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13369 from the code block
13371 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13372 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13375 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13376 block should be handled.
13379 @subsubheading Collection
13380 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13381 should be collected from the code block.
13385 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13386 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13387 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13388 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13389 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13390 @item @code{output}
13391 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13392 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13393 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13396 @subsubheading Type
13398 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13399 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13400 table or scalar depending on their value.
13403 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13404 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13405 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13406 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13408 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13409 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13410 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13411 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13412 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13413 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13415 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13416 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13417 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
13418 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13419 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13420 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13422 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
13423 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13425 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
13426 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13428 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13429 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13431 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13432 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13433 @code{:results value pp}.
13435 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13436 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13437 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13440 @subsubheading Handling
13441 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13442 results once they are collected.
13445 @item @code{silent}
13446 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13447 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13448 @item @code{replace}
13449 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13450 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13451 @code{:results output replace}.
13452 @item @code{append}
13453 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13454 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13455 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13456 @item @code{prepend}
13457 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13458 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13459 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13462 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
13463 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13465 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13466 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13467 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13468 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13469 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13470 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13471 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13472 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13474 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13475 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13476 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13478 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
13479 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13481 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13482 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13483 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13484 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13485 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13486 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13487 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13489 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13490 (e.g.@: @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13491 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13493 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13494 in your home directory, you could use
13497 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13498 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13502 @subsubheading Remote execution
13503 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13504 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13507 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13508 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13512 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13513 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13514 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13517 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13518 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13521 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13524 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13525 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13526 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13527 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13529 @subsubheading Further points
13533 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13534 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13535 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13537 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13538 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13539 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13540 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13541 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13542 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13543 which the link does not point.
13546 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13547 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13549 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13550 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13554 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13555 @code{:exports code}.
13556 @item @code{results}
13557 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13558 @code{:exports results}.
13560 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13561 @code{:exports both}.
13563 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13566 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13567 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13569 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13570 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13573 @item @code{tangle}
13574 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13575 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13576 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13578 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13579 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13581 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13582 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13583 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13586 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13587 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13589 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13590 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13591 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13593 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13594 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13595 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13596 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13597 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13598 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13602 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13604 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13605 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13607 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13609 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13611 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13612 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13614 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13616 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13617 references in the code block body in link comments.
13620 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13621 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13622 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13623 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13624 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13629 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13631 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13634 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13635 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13637 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13638 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13639 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13640 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13641 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13643 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13644 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13646 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13647 language where state is preserved.
13649 By default, a session is not started.
13651 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13652 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13653 interpreted language.
13655 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13656 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13658 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
13659 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
13660 argument can have one of three values: @code{yes}, @code{no}, or @code{tangle}.
13664 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13665 expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13667 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken when the code
13668 block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13669 @item @code{tangle}
13670 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13671 expanded before the block is tangled, however ``noweb'' references will not
13672 be expanded when the block is evaluated or exported.
13675 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13676 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13677 @code{<<reference>>}.
13678 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13679 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13680 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13693 -- multi-line body of example
13696 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13697 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13700 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13701 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13702 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13703 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13704 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13705 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13707 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13708 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13709 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13710 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13711 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13715 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13718 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13720 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13723 ** query all mounted disks
13728 ** strip the header row
13733 ** sort by the percent full
13735 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
13738 ** extract the mount point
13740 |awk '@{print $2@}'
13744 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
13745 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
13748 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
13749 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
13751 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
13752 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
13755 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
13756 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
13758 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
13759 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
13760 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
13761 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
13762 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
13763 outside of the Org-mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
13764 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
13768 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
13769 every time it is called.
13771 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
13772 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
13773 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
13774 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
13775 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
13778 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
13779 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
13780 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
13781 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
13782 changed since it was last run.
13786 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
13790 #+results[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
13794 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
13798 #+results[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
13802 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
13803 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
13805 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
13806 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
13807 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
13808 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
13809 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
13812 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
13815 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
13816 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
13818 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
13819 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
13820 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
13824 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
13825 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
13826 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
13827 default value yields the following results.
13830 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
13838 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
13842 #+results: echo-table
13849 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
13852 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
13860 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
13864 #+results: echo-table
13873 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
13874 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
13876 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
13877 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
13878 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
13879 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
13880 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
13881 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
13885 If an input table looks like it has column names
13886 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
13887 names will be removed from the table before
13888 processing, then reapplied to the results.
13891 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
13897 #+NAME: echo-table-again
13898 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
13899 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
13902 #+results: echo-table-again
13909 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
13910 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
13913 No column name pre-processing takes place
13916 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
13917 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e.@: the second row is not an
13921 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
13922 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
13924 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
13925 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
13929 No row name pre-processing will take place.
13932 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
13933 and is then reapplied to the results.
13936 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
13937 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
13938 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
13940 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
13941 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
13942 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
13945 #+results: echo-table-once-again
13946 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
13947 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
13950 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
13951 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
13955 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
13956 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
13958 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
13959 (e.g.@: @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
13960 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
13961 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
13963 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
13964 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
13965 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
13966 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
13967 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
13968 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
13969 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
13970 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
13974 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
13976 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
13977 @item never-export or no-export
13978 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
13981 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
13984 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
13985 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
13988 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
13989 @section Results of evaluation
13990 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
13991 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
13993 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
13994 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
13995 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
13996 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
13998 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
13999 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14000 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14001 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14004 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14005 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14006 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14008 @subsection Non-session
14009 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14010 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14011 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14012 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14013 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14014 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14015 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14017 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14018 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14020 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14021 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14022 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14023 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14026 @subsection Session
14027 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14028 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14029 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14030 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14031 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14032 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14033 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14034 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14036 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14037 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14038 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14039 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14042 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14043 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14044 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14045 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14046 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14047 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14048 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14051 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14062 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14064 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14076 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14077 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14080 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14081 @section Noweb reference syntax
14082 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14083 @cindex syntax, noweb
14084 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14086 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14087 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14088 familiar Noweb syntax:
14091 <<code-block-name>>
14094 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14095 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14096 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14097 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14098 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14099 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14101 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14102 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14103 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14106 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14109 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14110 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14111 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14112 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14115 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org-mode files consider setting the
14116 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14117 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14118 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14121 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14122 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14123 @cindex code block, key bindings
14125 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14128 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14131 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14133 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14135 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14137 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14139 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14142 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14144 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14146 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14147 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14149 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14150 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14152 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14153 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14155 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14156 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14158 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14159 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14161 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14162 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14164 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14165 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14167 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14168 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14170 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14171 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14173 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14174 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14176 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14177 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14179 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14180 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14182 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14183 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14185 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14186 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14188 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14189 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14191 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14192 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14194 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14195 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14197 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14198 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14200 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14201 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14203 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14204 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14206 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14207 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14209 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14210 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14213 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14214 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14216 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14217 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14218 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14219 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14220 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14221 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14222 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14223 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14224 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14227 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14228 @section Batch execution
14229 @cindex code block, batch execution
14230 @cindex source code, batch execution
14232 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14233 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14235 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14239 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14241 # tangle files with org-mode
14245 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
14247 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14249 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14252 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
14254 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14255 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
14256 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14257 (mapc (lambda (file)
14258 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14260 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14263 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14264 @chapter Miscellaneous
14267 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14268 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14269 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14270 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14271 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14272 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14273 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14274 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14275 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14276 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14277 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14281 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14282 @section Completion
14283 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14284 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14285 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14286 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14287 @cindex completion, of tags
14288 @cindex completion, of property keys
14289 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14290 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14291 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14292 @cindex dictionary word completion
14293 @cindex option keyword completion
14294 @cindex tag completion
14295 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14297 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14298 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14299 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14300 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14301 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14303 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14304 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14305 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14308 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14310 Complete word at point
14313 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14315 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14317 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14318 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14320 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14321 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14322 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14323 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14325 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14326 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14329 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14331 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14332 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14333 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14334 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14336 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14337 i.e.@: valid keys for this line.
14339 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14343 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14344 @section Easy Templates
14345 @cindex template insertion
14346 @cindex insertion, of templates
14348 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14349 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14350 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14351 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14352 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14354 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14355 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14356 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14358 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14360 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14361 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
14362 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
14363 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
14364 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
14365 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
14366 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
14367 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
14368 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
14369 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
14370 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
14371 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
14372 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+index:} line
14373 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+include:} line
14376 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14377 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14379 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14380 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14381 additional details.
14383 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14384 @section Speed keys
14386 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14387 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14389 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14390 beginning of a headline, i.e.@: before the first star. Configure the variable
14391 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14392 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14393 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14394 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14395 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14396 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14398 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14399 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14401 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14402 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14404 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14406 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14407 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14408 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14409 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14410 these precautions intact.
14412 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14413 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14414 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14416 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14419 @item Source code blocks
14420 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14421 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14422 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14423 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14424 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14426 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14427 which take off the default security brakes.
14429 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14430 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14431 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14432 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14433 ask and nil not to ask.
14436 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14439 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14440 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14441 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14444 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14445 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14446 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14449 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14450 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14452 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14453 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14456 @item Formulas in tables
14457 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14458 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14461 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14462 @section Customization
14463 @cindex customization
14464 @cindex options, for customization
14465 @cindex variables, for customization
14467 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
14468 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14469 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14470 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14471 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14472 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14473 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14475 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14476 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14477 @cindex in-buffer settings
14478 @cindex special keywords
14480 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14481 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14482 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14483 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14484 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14485 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14486 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14487 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14488 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14490 @vindex org-archive-location
14492 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14493 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14494 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14495 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14496 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14498 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14499 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14500 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14501 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14502 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14503 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14504 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14506 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14507 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14508 @vindex org-table-formula
14509 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14510 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14511 The global version of this variable is
14512 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14513 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14514 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14516 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14517 @vindex org-drawers
14518 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
14519 @code{org-drawers}.
14520 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14521 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14522 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14523 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14524 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14525 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14526 @vindex org-highest-priority
14527 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14528 @vindex org-default-priority
14529 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14530 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
14531 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14532 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14533 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14534 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14535 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14536 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14537 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14538 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14539 (i.e.@: when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14540 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14541 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14542 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14543 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14546 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14547 Org file is being visited.
14549 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14550 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14551 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14553 @vindex org-startup-folded
14554 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14555 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14556 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14557 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14559 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14560 content @r{all headlines}
14561 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14562 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14565 @vindex org-startup-indented
14566 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14567 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14568 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14569 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14571 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14572 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14575 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14576 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14577 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14578 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14580 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14581 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14583 align @r{align all tables}
14584 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14587 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14588 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14589 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14590 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14591 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14592 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14594 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14595 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14598 @vindex org-log-done
14599 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14600 @vindex org-log-repeat
14601 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14602 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14603 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14604 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14605 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14606 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14607 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14608 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14609 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14610 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14611 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14612 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14613 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14614 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14615 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14616 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14617 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14618 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14619 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14620 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14622 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14623 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14624 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14625 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14626 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14627 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14628 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14629 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14630 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14631 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14632 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14633 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14634 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14635 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14636 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14637 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14638 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14640 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14641 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14642 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14643 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14644 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14645 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14646 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14647 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14648 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14649 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14651 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14652 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14653 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14654 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14655 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14656 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14658 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14659 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14660 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14661 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14662 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14663 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14665 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14667 @vindex constants-unit-system
14668 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14669 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14670 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14671 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14673 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14674 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14676 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14677 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14678 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14679 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14680 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14681 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14682 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14683 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14684 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14685 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14686 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14687 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14688 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14689 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14690 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14692 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14693 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14694 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14695 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14696 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14697 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14698 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14699 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14700 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14702 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14703 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14704 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14705 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14706 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14708 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14709 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14711 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14712 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14713 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14714 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14715 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14717 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14718 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14720 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14721 @vindex org-tag-alist
14722 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14723 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14724 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14726 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
14727 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
14728 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
14729 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
14730 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
14731 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
14732 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
14733 @ref{Export options}.
14734 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
14735 @vindex org-todo-keywords
14736 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
14737 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
14740 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
14741 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
14743 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
14745 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
14746 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
14747 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
14748 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
14749 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
14750 what this means in different contexts.
14754 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
14755 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
14757 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
14758 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
14761 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
14762 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
14764 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
14767 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
14768 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
14771 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
14772 corresponding links in this buffer.
14774 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
14775 drawer, offer property commands.
14777 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
14778 definition, and vice versa.
14780 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
14782 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
14785 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
14788 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
14791 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
14794 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
14795 @section A cleaner outline view
14796 @cindex hiding leading stars
14797 @cindex dynamic indentation
14798 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
14799 @cindex clean outline view
14801 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
14802 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
14803 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
14804 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
14805 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
14809 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
14810 ** Second level | * Second level
14811 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
14812 some text | some text
14813 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
14814 more text | more text
14815 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
14821 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
14822 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
14823 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
14824 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
14825 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
14826 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
14827 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
14828 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
14829 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
14830 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
14831 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
14832 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
14833 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
14834 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
14835 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
14836 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
14837 individual files using
14843 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
14844 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
14845 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
14850 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
14851 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
14852 with the headline, like
14856 more text, now indented
14859 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
14860 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
14861 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
14862 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
14865 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14866 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
14867 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
14868 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
14872 #+STARTUP: hidestars
14873 #+STARTUP: showstars
14876 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
14880 * Top level headline
14888 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
14889 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
14890 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
14891 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
14892 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
14893 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
14894 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
14897 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14898 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
14899 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
14900 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
14901 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
14902 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
14903 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
14904 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
14905 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
14912 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
14913 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
14914 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
14915 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
14918 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
14919 @section Using Org on a tty
14920 @cindex tty key bindings
14922 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
14923 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
14924 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
14925 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
14926 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
14927 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
14928 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
14929 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
14930 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
14931 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
14932 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
14934 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
14935 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
14936 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
14937 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
14938 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
14939 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
14940 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
14941 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
14942 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
14943 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
14944 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
14945 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14946 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
14947 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14948 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14949 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14950 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14951 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14952 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14953 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
14957 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
14958 @section Interaction with other packages
14959 @cindex packages, interaction with other
14960 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
14961 with other code out there.
14964 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
14965 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
14968 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
14969 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
14972 @cindex @file{calc.el}
14973 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
14974 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
14975 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
14976 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
14977 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
14978 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
14979 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
14980 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
14981 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
14982 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
14983 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
14984 @cindex @file{constants.el}
14985 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
14986 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14987 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
14988 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
14989 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
14990 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
14991 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
14992 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
14993 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
14994 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
14995 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
14996 @file{constants.el}.
14997 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
14998 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
14999 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15000 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15001 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15002 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15003 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15004 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15005 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15007 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15008 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15010 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15011 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15012 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15013 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15014 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15015 @cindex Wiegley, John
15016 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15017 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15018 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15019 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15020 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15021 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15022 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15023 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15024 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15025 @cindex @file{table.el}
15026 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15028 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15029 @cindex @file{table.el}
15030 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15032 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15033 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15034 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15035 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15036 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15037 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15038 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15041 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15042 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15044 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15045 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15046 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15047 format. See the documentation string of the command
15048 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15051 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15052 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15053 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15054 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15055 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15056 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15057 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15060 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15061 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15065 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15066 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15067 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15068 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15069 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15070 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15071 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15072 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15073 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15074 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15075 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15076 cursor moves across a special context.
15078 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15079 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15080 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15081 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15082 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15083 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15084 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15085 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15086 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15087 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15088 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15089 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15090 buffer (but not during date selection).
15093 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15094 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15095 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15098 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15099 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15100 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15101 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15103 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15104 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15105 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15106 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15107 fixed this problem:
15110 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15112 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15113 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15116 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15117 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15121 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15122 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15125 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15128 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15130 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15131 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15132 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15133 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15136 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15137 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15138 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15139 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15140 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15141 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15145 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15146 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15147 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15148 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15149 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15152 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15153 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15155 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15156 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15157 another key for this command, or override the key in
15158 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15161 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15166 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15167 @section org-crypt.el
15168 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15169 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15171 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15172 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15175 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15176 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15177 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15179 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15183 (require 'org-crypt)
15184 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15185 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15187 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15188 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15189 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15191 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15192 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15193 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15194 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15197 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15199 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15202 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15203 being encrypted again.
15205 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15209 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15213 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
15214 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15215 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15216 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15217 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15218 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15219 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15220 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15221 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15222 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15225 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15229 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15230 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15231 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15232 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15233 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15235 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15236 @section Add-on packages
15237 @cindex add-on packages
15239 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15240 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15241 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15242 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15243 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15244 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15248 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15249 @section Adding hyperlink types
15250 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15252 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15253 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15254 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15255 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15256 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15260 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15264 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15265 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15267 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15268 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15270 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15272 (defun org-man-open (path)
15273 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15274 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15275 (funcall org-man-command path))
15277 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15278 "Store a link to a manpage."
15279 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15280 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15281 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15282 (link (concat "man:" page))
15283 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15284 (org-store-link-props
15287 :description description))))
15289 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15290 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15291 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15292 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15293 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15294 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15298 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15302 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15309 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15312 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15315 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15316 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15317 that will be called to follow such a link.
15319 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15320 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15321 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15322 buffer displaying a man page.
15325 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15326 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15327 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15328 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15329 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15330 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15331 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15333 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15334 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15335 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15336 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15337 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15338 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15339 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15340 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15341 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15342 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15343 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15344 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15346 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15347 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
15348 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15349 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15351 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15352 @section Context-sensitive commands
15353 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15354 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15355 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15357 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15358 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15359 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15361 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15362 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15363 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15364 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15365 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15366 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15367 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15371 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15372 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15373 (if (save-excursion
15374 (beginning-of-line 1)
15375 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15376 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15377 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15378 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15380 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15383 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15384 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15385 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15386 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15387 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15390 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15391 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15392 @cindex tables, in other modes
15393 @cindex lists, in other modes
15394 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15396 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15397 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15398 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15399 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15400 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15403 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15404 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15405 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15406 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15407 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15408 for a very flexible system.
15410 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15411 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15412 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15413 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15417 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15418 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15419 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15420 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15423 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15424 @subsection Radio tables
15425 @cindex radio tables
15427 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15428 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15429 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15430 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15433 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15434 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15438 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15439 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15443 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15447 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15448 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15449 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15450 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15451 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15452 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15453 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15457 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15460 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15461 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15462 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15463 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15464 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15465 additional columns.
15469 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15470 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15471 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15472 number of different solutions:
15476 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15477 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15478 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15480 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15481 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15484 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15485 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15486 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15487 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15491 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15492 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15493 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15495 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15496 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15497 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15498 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15499 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15500 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15501 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15502 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15503 will then get the following template:
15505 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15507 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15508 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15510 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15516 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15517 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15518 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15519 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15520 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15521 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15522 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15523 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15524 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15525 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15526 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15527 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15530 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15531 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15533 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15534 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15535 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15536 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15537 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15538 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15539 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15540 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15545 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15546 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15548 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15549 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
15550 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15551 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e.@: to not produce
15552 header and footer commands of the target table:
15555 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15556 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15557 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15558 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15562 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15563 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15564 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15565 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15566 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15567 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15568 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15572 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15573 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15574 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15575 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15578 @item :splice nil/t
15579 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15580 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15583 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15584 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15585 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15586 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15587 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15588 function must return a formatted string.
15591 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15592 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15593 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15594 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15595 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15596 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15597 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15598 supplied instead of strings.
15601 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15602 @subsection Translator functions
15603 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15604 @cindex translator function
15606 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15607 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15608 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15609 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15610 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15611 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15612 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15613 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15614 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15618 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15619 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15620 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15621 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15624 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15625 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15626 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15627 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15628 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15632 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15633 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15634 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e.@: the
15635 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15636 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15637 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15638 overrule the default with
15641 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15644 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15645 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15646 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15647 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15648 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15649 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15653 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15654 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15658 Please check the documentation string of the function
15659 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15660 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15661 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15662 using the generic function.
15664 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15665 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15666 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15667 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15668 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15669 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15670 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15671 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15672 others can benefit from your work.
15674 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15675 @subsection Radio lists
15676 @cindex radio lists
15677 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15679 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15680 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15681 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15682 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15684 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15688 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15690 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15692 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15695 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15698 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15703 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15704 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15706 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15715 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
15716 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
15718 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
15719 @section Dynamic blocks
15720 @cindex dynamic blocks
15722 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
15723 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
15724 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
15725 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
15727 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
15728 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
15729 the content of the block.
15731 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
15733 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
15738 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
15741 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
15742 Update dynamic block at point.
15743 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
15744 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
15747 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
15748 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
15749 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
15750 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
15751 extra parameter @code{:content}.
15753 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
15754 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
15755 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
15756 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
15760 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
15766 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
15769 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
15770 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
15771 (insert "Last block update at: "
15772 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
15775 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
15776 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
15777 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
15778 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
15781 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
15782 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
15784 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
15785 @section Special agenda views
15786 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
15788 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
15789 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
15790 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
15791 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
15792 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
15793 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
15794 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
15795 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
15796 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
15797 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
15798 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
15800 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
15801 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
15802 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
15803 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
15804 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
15805 the subtree belonging to the project line.
15807 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
15808 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
15809 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
15810 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
15811 search should continue from there.
15814 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
15815 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
15816 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
15817 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
15818 nil ; tag found, do not skip
15819 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
15822 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
15826 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
15827 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
15828 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
15829 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
15832 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
15833 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
15834 meaningful header in the agenda view.
15836 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15837 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
15838 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
15839 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
15840 your custom search function, simply do a search for
15841 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
15842 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
15843 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
15844 you really want to have.
15846 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
15847 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
15848 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
15851 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
15852 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
15853 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
15854 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
15855 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
15856 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
15857 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
15858 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
15859 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
15860 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
15861 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
15862 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
15863 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
15864 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
15865 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
15866 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
15867 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
15868 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
15869 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
15870 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
15873 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
15874 like this, even without defining a special function:
15877 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
15878 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
15879 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
15880 'regexp ":waiting:"))
15881 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
15884 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
15885 @section Extracting agenda information
15886 @cindex agenda, pipe
15887 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
15889 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
15890 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
15891 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
15892 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
15893 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
15894 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
15895 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
15896 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
15897 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
15898 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
15899 current TODO list, you could use
15902 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
15905 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
15906 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
15907 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
15908 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
15911 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
15912 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
15916 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
15919 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
15920 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
15921 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
15922 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
15923 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
15928 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
15929 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
15931 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
15932 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
15933 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
15934 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
15938 category @r{The category of the item}
15939 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
15940 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
15941 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
15942 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
15943 diary @r{imported from diary}
15944 deadline @r{a deadline}
15945 scheduled @r{scheduled}
15946 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
15947 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
15948 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
15949 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
15950 block @r{entry has date block including date}
15951 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
15952 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
15953 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
15954 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
15955 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
15956 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
15957 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
15961 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
15962 led to the selection of the item.
15964 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
15965 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
15966 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
15971 # define the Emacs command to run
15972 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
15974 # run it and capture the output
15975 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
15977 # loop over all lines
15978 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
15979 # get the individual values
15980 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
15981 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
15982 # process and print
15983 print "[ ] $head\n";
15987 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
15988 @section Using the property API
15989 @cindex API, for properties
15990 @cindex properties, API
15992 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
15995 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
15996 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
15997 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
15998 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
15999 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16000 if the property key was used several times.@*
16001 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16002 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16003 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16005 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16006 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16007 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
16008 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16009 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16010 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16011 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16012 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16015 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16016 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16019 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16020 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16023 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16024 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16027 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16028 Insert a property drawer at point.
16031 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16032 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
16033 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16036 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16037 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16038 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16041 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16042 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16043 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16046 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16047 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16048 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16051 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16052 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16053 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16056 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16057 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16058 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16059 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16060 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16061 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16062 responsible for this property.
16065 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16066 @section Using the mapping API
16067 @cindex API, for mapping
16068 @cindex mapping entries, API
16070 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16071 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16072 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16073 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16076 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16077 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16079 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16080 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16081 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16082 returned as a list.
16084 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16085 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16086 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16087 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16088 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16089 if you have removed (e.g.@: archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16090 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16091 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16092 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16095 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16096 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16097 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16098 visited by the iteration.
16100 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16103 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16104 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16105 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16106 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16108 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16109 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16110 agenda-with-archives
16111 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16113 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16116 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16117 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16119 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16121 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16122 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16123 function or Lisp form
16124 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16125 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16126 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16127 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16131 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16132 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16133 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16134 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16136 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16137 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16138 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16141 @defun org-priority &optional action
16142 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16143 possible values for ACTION.
16146 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16147 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16148 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16152 Promote the current entry.
16156 Demote the current entry.
16159 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16160 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16161 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16165 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16166 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16169 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16170 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16173 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16176 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16177 @appendix MobileOrg
16181 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
16182 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
16183 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org mode
16184 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
16185 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
16186 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16189 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16190 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16191 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16193 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16194 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16195 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16196 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16197 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16198 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16199 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16202 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16203 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16204 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16207 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16208 @section Setting up the staging area
16210 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16211 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16212 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16213 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16214 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16215 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16216 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16217 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16218 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16219 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16220 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16222 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16223 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16224 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16225 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16226 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16227 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16228 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16232 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16235 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16236 and to read captured notes from there.
16238 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16239 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16241 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16242 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16243 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16244 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16245 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16246 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16247 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16248 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16249 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16250 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16251 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16252 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16253 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16254 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16255 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16256 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16257 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
16258 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16260 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16261 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16263 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16264 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16265 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16266 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16267 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16271 Org moves all entries found in
16272 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16273 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16274 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16275 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16277 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16278 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16279 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16280 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16281 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16282 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16283 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16284 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16286 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16287 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16288 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16289 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16294 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16295 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16296 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16297 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16298 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16299 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16300 this flagged entry is finished.
16305 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16306 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16307 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16308 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16309 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16310 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16311 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16313 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
16314 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16315 @cindex acknowledgments
16319 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16320 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16321 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16322 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16323 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16324 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16325 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16326 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16327 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16328 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16329 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16330 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16331 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16332 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16333 functionality directly into a notes file.
16335 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16336 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16337 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16338 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16339 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16340 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16341 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16344 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16347 @item Bastien Guerry
16348 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16349 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16350 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16351 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16352 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
16353 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16354 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16355 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16356 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16357 programming and reproducible research.
16359 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16360 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16361 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16362 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16363 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16364 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16365 @item Sebastian Rose
16366 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16367 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16368 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16369 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16370 single-key navigation.
16373 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
16374 know what I am missing here!
16379 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16381 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16383 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16386 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16388 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16390 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16392 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16394 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16395 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16397 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16400 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16401 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16402 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16404 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16406 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16408 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16409 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16412 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16414 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16415 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16416 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16418 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16419 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16421 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16422 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16423 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16425 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16428 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16430 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16432 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16433 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16435 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16437 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16439 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16441 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16444 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16445 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16447 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16449 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16451 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16453 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16456 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16457 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16458 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16460 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16463 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16465 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16466 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16468 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16470 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16472 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16473 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16475 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16476 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16478 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16479 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16480 small fixes and patches.
16482 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16484 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16486 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16489 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16492 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16494 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16495 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16497 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16499 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16501 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16502 file links, and TAGS.
16504 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16505 version of the reference card.
16507 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16510 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16512 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16513 links, among other things.
16515 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16516 provided frequent feedback.
16518 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16519 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16521 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16523 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16526 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16527 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16529 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16531 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16532 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16534 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16537 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16538 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16540 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16543 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16545 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16546 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16548 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16549 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16551 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16552 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16554 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16557 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16559 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16560 tweaks and features.
16562 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16563 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16565 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16566 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16568 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16569 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16571 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16572 chapter about publishing.
16574 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16576 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16577 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16579 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16580 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16581 concept index for HTML export.
16583 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16586 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16588 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16591 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16594 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16597 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16600 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16601 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16606 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16607 @unnumbered Concept index
16611 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16612 @unnumbered Key index
16616 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16617 @unnumbered Command and function index
16621 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16622 @unnumbered Variable index
16624 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16625 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16626 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16632 @c Local variables:
16634 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16635 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16636 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16640 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre